blob: c8e9cbc465715ec413652dab530e110ab64be05d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaud0089302020-04-17 14:19:38 +02007 2020/04/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100604 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200605 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100607 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100609 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200610 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200612 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200613 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200614 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200675 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200676 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200677 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100678 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200679 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200680 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100681 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100682 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100683 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.session-timeout
685 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200686 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100687 - tune.maxaccept
688 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200689 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200690 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200691 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.rcvbuf.client
693 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100694 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200695 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.sndbuf.client
697 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100698 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100699 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200700 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200702 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200703 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100704 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200705 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100706 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
708 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
709 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100710 - tune.zlib.memlevel
711 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200713 * Debugging
714 - debug
715 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200716 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200717
718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007193.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720------------------------------------
721
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200722ca-base <dir>
723 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100724 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
725 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
726 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728chroot <jail dir>
729 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
730 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
731 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
732 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
733 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100734 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100735
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100736cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
737 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
738 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
739 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
740 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
741 set. These sets have the format
742
743 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
744
745 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
748 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100749 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
750 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100752 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100753 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100754 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
756 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
757 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
758 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100759
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100760 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
761 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
762 on the machine's word size.
763
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100764 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
766 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
767 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
768 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
769 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
770 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100771
772 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100773 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
774
775 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
776 # first 4 CPUs
777
778 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
779 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
780 # word size.
781
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100782 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100783 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
789 # and so on.
790 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
791 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100794 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100795 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
796 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
797 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
798
799 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
800 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
802
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100803 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
804 # and a thread range.
805 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
807 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
808
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200809crt-base <dir>
810 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100811 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
812 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200813
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200814daemon
815 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
816 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100817 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
818 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820deviceatlas-json-file <path>
821 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100822 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200823
824deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100825 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200826 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
827
828deviceatlas-separator <char>
829 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
830 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
831
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100832deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200833 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
834 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
835 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900837external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100838 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
839 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100840 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
841 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
842 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
843 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
844 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900845
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846gid <number>
847 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
848 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
849 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100850 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
851 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100853
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100854group <group name>
855 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
856 See also "gid" and "user".
857
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100858hard-stop-after <time>
859 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
860
861 Arguments :
862 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
863 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
864 SIGUSR1 signal.
865
866 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
867 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
868 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
869
870 Example:
871 global
872 hard-stop-after 30s
873
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200874h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
875 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
876 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
877 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
878 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500879 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200880 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
881 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
882 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
883 specified in a proxy.
884
885 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
886 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
887 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
888 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
889 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
890 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
891 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
892
893 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
894 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
895 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
896 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
897 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
898
899 Example:
900 global
901 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
902
903 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
904 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
905
906h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
907 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
908 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
909 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
910 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
911 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
912 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
913 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
914 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
915
916 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
917 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
918 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
919
920 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
921 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
922
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100923insecure-fork-wanted
924 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
925 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
926 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
927 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
928 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
929 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
930 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
931 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
932 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
933 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
934 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
935 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
936 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
937 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
938 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
939 disable it.
940
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100941insecure-setuid-wanted
942 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
943 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
944 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
945 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
946 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
947 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
948 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
949 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
950 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
951 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
952 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
953 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
954 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
955 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
956
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100957issuers-chain-path <dir>
958 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
959 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
960 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
961 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
962 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
963 "issuers-chain-path".
964 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
965 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
966 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
967 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
968 will share the chain in memory.
969
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200970log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
971 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100972 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100973 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100974 configured with "log global".
975
976 <address> can be one of:
977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100978 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100979 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
980 port).
981
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100982 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
983 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
984 port).
985
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100986 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100987 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
988 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100989 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100990
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100991 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
992 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
993 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
994 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
995 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
996 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
997 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
998 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
999 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1000 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1001 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1002 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1003 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1004 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001005 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1006 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001007
1008 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1009 "fd@2", see above.
1010
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001011 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1012 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1013 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1014 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1015 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1016
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001017 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1018 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001019
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001020 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1021 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1022 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1023 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1024 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1025 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1026 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1027 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1028 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1029 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001030 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1031 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001032
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001033 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1034 one of the following :
1035
1036 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1037 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1038
1039 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1040 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1041
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001042 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1043 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1044 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1045 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1046 logger consumes.
1047
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001048 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1049 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1050 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1051 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1052
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001053 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1054 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1055 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1056 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1057 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1058
1059 <sample_size>
1060 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1061 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1062 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1063 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1064 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1065
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001066 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001068 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1069 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1070 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1071
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001072 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1073 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1074 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1075 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076
1077 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001078 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1079 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1080 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1081 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1082 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1083 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001085 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001087log-send-hostname [<string>]
1088 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1089 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1090 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1091 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1092 the logs.
1093
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001094log-tag <string>
1095 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1096 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1097 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001098 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001099
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100lua-load <file>
1101 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1102 used multiple times.
1103
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1105 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1106 variable.
1107 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1108 to "path".
1109
1110 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1111 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1112 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1113 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1114 will be checked earlier.
1115
1116 As an example by specifying the following path:
1117
1118 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1119 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1120
1121 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1122 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1123 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1124 paths if that does not exist either.
1125
1126 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1127 documentation.
1128
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001129master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001130 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1131 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1132 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001134 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1135 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001136 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1137 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1138 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1139 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1140 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001141
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001142 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001144mworker-max-reloads <number>
1145 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001146 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001147 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1148 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1149 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151nbproc <number>
1152 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1153 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1154 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001155 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1156 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001157 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1158 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001160nbthread <number>
1161 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001162 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1163 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1164 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1165 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1166 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001167 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1168 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1169 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1170 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1171 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1172 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1173 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001174
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001176 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1178 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1179
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001180presetenv <name> <value>
1181 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1182 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1183 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1184 and "unsetenv".
1185
1186resetenv [<name> ...]
1187 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1188 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1189 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1190 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1191 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1192 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1193 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1194 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1195
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001196stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001197 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1198 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1199 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1200 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1201 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1202 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001203 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001204 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1205 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1206 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1207 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001208
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001209server-state-base <directory>
1210 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001211 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1212 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001213
1214server-state-file <file>
1215 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1216 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1217 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1218 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1219 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1220 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1221 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1222 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001223 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1224 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001225
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001226setenv <name> <value>
1227 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1228 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1229 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1230 and "unsetenv".
1231
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001232set-dumpable
1233 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001234 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1235 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1236 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1237 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1238 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1239 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1240 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1241 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1242 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1243 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1244 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1245 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1246 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1247 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1248 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1249 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1250 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001251
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001252ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1254 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001255 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001256 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001257 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1258 information and recommendations see e.g.
1259 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1260 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1261 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1262 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001263
1264ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1266 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1267 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1268 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1269 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001270 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1271 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1272 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001273 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001274
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001275ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1277 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1278 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1279 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1280 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1281
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001282ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1284 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1285 keyword to see available options.
1286
1287 Example:
1288 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001289 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001290
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001291ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1293 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001294 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001295 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001296 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1297 information and recommendations see e.g.
1298 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1299 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1300 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1301 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1302 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001303
1304ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1306 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1307 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1308 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1309 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001310 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1311 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1312 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1313 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001314
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001315ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1317 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1318 keyword to see available options.
1319
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001320ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1322 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1323 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001324 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001325 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001326 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1327 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1328 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1329 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001330 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1331 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1332 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1333
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001334ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001335 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1336 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1337
1338 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1339 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1340 optimize the startup time.
1341
1342 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1343 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1344 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1345
1346 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001347 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001348
1349 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1350 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1351 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1352 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1353 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1354 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001355 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001356 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1357
1358 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1359
1360 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1361
1362 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1363 not provided in the PEM file.
1364
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001365 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1366 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1367
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001368 The default behavior is "all".
1369
1370 Example:
1371 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1372 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1373 ssl-load-extra-files none
1374
1375 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1376
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001377ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1378 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1379 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1380 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1381
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001382ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1383 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1384 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1385 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1386 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1387 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1388 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1389 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1390 bits does not need it.
1391
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001392stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1393 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1394 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1395 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001396 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001397 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001398
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001399 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1400 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1401 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001402
1403stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1404 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1405 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001406 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001407
1408stats maxconn <connections>
1409 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1410 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1411
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001412uid <number>
1413 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1414 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1415 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1416 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1417
1418ulimit-n <number>
1419 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1420 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1421 option.
1422
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001423unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1424 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1425
1426 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1427 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1428 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1429 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1430 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1431 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1432 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1433 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1434 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1435 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1436
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001437unsetenv [<name> ...]
1438 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1439 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1440 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1441 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1442 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1443 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1444 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1445
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001446user <user name>
1447 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1448 See also "uid" and "group".
1449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001450node <name>
1451 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1452
1453 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1454 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1455 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1456 traffic.
1457
1458description <text>
1459 Add a text that describes the instance.
1460
1461 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1462 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1463 "<" and ">" characters.
1464
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100146551degrees-data-file <file path>
1466 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001467 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001468
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001469 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001470 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1471
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000147251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001473 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1474 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1475 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1476
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001477 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001478 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1479
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200148051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001481 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1482 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
148751degrees-cache-size <number>
1488 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1489 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1490 By default, this cache is disabled.
1491
1492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001495wurfl-data-file <file path>
1496 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1497 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1498
1499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1500 with USE_WURFL=1.
1501
1502wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1503 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1504 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1505 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1506
1507 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1508
1509 Valid WURFL properties are:
1510 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1511
1512 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1513 device.
1514
1515 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1516 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1517
1518 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1519 particular web request.
1520
1521 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1522 used Libwurfl API version.
1523
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001524 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1525 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1526
1527 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1528 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1529
1530 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1531
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001532 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1533 with USE_WURFL=1.
1534
1535wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1536 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1537 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1538
1539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1540 with USE_WURFL=1.
1541
1542wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1543 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1544 thus before the chroot.
1545
1546 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1547 with USE_WURFL=1.
1548
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001549wurfl-cache-size <size>
1550 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1551 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001552 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001553 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001554
1555 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1556 with USE_WURFL=1.
1557
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001558strict-limits
1559 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1560 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1561 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1562 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1563 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1564 keyword.
1565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015663.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567-----------------------
1568
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001569busy-polling
1570 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1571 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1572 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1573 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1574 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1575 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1576 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1577 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1578 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1579 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1580 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1581 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1582 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1583 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1584 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1585 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1586 "poll" pollers.
1587
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001588 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1589 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1590 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1591
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001592max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1593 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1594 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1595 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1596 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1597 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1598 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1599 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1600 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001602maxconn <number>
1603 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1604 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1605 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001606 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1607 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1608 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1609 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001610 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1611 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1612 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1613 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1614 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1615 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001617maxconnrate <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1619 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1620 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1621 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1622 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1623 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1624 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1625 fairness.
1626
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001627maxcomprate <number>
1628 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001629 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001630 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1631 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1632 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001633 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001634 default value.
1635
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001636maxcompcpuusage <number>
1637 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1638 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1639 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1640 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1641 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1642 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1643 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1644 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1645
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001646maxpipes <number>
1647 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1648 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1649 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1650 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1651 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1652 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1653
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001654maxsessrate <number>
1655 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1656 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1657 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1658 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1659 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1660 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1661 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1662 fairness.
1663
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001664maxsslconn <number>
1665 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1666 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1667 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1668 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1669 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1670 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1671 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001672 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1673 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1674 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1675 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1676 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1677 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1678 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001680maxsslrate <number>
1681 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1682 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1683 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1684 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1685 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1686 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1687 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1688 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1689 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1690 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1691
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001692maxzlibmem <number>
1693 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1694 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1695 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001696 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1697 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1698 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700noepoll
1701 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704
1705nokqueue
1706 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1707 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1708 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1709
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001710noevports
1711 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1712 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1713 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1714 also "nopoll".
1715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001716nopoll
1717 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1718 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001720 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1721 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001723nosplice
1724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1731 "option splice-response".
1732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001733nogetaddrinfo
1734 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1735 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1736
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001737noreuseport
1738 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1739 command line argument "-dR".
1740
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001741profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1742 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1743 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1744 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1745 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001746 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001747 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1748 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1749 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1750 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1751
1752 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1753 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1754 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1755 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1756 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001757 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1758 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1759 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1760 CLI.
1761
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001762spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001763 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1764 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1765 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1766 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1767 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1768 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001769
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001770ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001771 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001772 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001773 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1774 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1775 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1776 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1777 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001778 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1779 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001780 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1781 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1782 openssl configuration file uses:
1783 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1784
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001785ssl-mode-async
1786 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001787 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001788 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1789 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1790 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001791 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001792 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001793
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001794tune.buffers.limit <number>
1795 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1796 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1797 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1798 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1799 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001800 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001801 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1802 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1803 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1804 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1805 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1806 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1807 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1808 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1809 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1810
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001811tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1812 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1813 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1814 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1815 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1816
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001817tune.bufsize <number>
1818 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1819 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1820 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1821 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1822 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1823 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1824 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001825 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1826 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1827 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001828 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001829 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1830 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1831 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001833tune.chksize <number>
1834 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1835 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1836 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1837 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1838 checks whenever possible.
1839
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001840tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1841 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1842 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1843 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1844 this value. The default value is 1.
1845
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001846tune.fail-alloc
1847 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1848 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1849 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1850 gracefully.
1851
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001852tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1853 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1854 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1855 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1856 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1857 change it.
1858
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001859tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1860 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1862 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001863 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1864 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1865 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1866 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1867 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1868
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001869tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1870 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1871 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1872 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1873 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1874 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1875 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1876 recommended not to change this value.
1877
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001878tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1879 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1880 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1881 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1882 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1883 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1884 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1885 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1886
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001887tune.http.cookielen <number>
1888 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1889 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1890 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1891 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1892 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1893 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1894 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1895 to change this value.
1896
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001897tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001898 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1899 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001900 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001901 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001902 configuration directives too.
1903 The default value is 1024.
1904
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001905tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1906 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1907 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1908 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1909 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1910 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1911 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001912 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1913 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1914 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001915
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001916tune.idletimer <timeout>
1917 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1918 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1919 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1920 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1921 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1922 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001923 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001924 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001925 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1926
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001927tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1928 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1929 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1930 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1931 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1932 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1933 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1934 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1935 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1936 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1937
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001938tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1939 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001940 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001941 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1942 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001943 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001944 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1945 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1946
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001947tune.lua.maxmem
1948 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1949 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1950 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1951 memory.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1954 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001955 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1956 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001958
1959tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1960 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1961 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1962 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1963 check servers.
1964
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001965tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1966 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1967 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1968 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001971tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001972 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1973 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1974 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1975 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1976 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1977 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1978 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1979 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1980 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1981 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001982
1983tune.maxpollevents <number>
1984 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1985 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1986 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1987 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1988 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1989
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001990tune.maxrewrite <number>
1991 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1992 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1993 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1994 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1995 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1996 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1997 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1998 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1999 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2000 bufsize.
2001
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002002tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2003 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2004 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2005 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2006 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2007 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2008 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2009 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2010 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2011 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002012 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2013 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002014 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2015 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2016 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2017 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2018 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2019 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2020 setting this parameter to 0.
2021
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002022tune.pipesize <number>
2023 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2024 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2025 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2026 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2027 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2028 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2029
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002030tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2031 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2032 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2033 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2034 default is 20.
2035
2036tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2037 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2038 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2039 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2040 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2041 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2042 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002043 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002044
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002045tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2046tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2047 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2048 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2049 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002050 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002051 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002052 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2053 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2054
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002055tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002056 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002057 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2058 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2059 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2060 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2061
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002062tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002063 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002064 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2065 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2066
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2068tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2069 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2070 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2071 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002072 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002074 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2075 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2076 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2077 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2078 notifying haproxy again.
2079
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002080tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002081 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2082 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2083 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002084 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002085 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002086 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002087 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2088 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2089 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002090 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2091 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002092
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002093tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002094 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002095 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2096 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2097 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2098 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2099 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2100
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002101tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2102 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002103 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002104 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2105 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2106 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2107 being used for too long.
2108
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002109tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2110 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2111 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2112 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2113 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2114 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2115 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2116 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2117 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2118 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2119 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002120 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002121 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002122
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002123tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2124 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2125 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2126 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2127 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2128 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2129 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2130 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002131 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2132 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002133
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002134tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2135 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2136 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2137 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2138 1000 entries.
2139
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002140tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2141 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2142 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2143 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2144
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002145tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002146tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002147tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2148tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2149tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002150 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2151 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2152 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2153 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2154 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2155 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2156 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2157 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002158
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002159 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2160 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2161 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2162 all available space is consumed.
2163 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2164 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2165 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002166
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002167tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2168 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002169 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002170 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002172 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2173
2174tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2175 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2176 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002177 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2178 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021803.3. Debugging
2181--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002182
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002183debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2185 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2186 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2187 system startup.
2188
2189quiet
2190 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2191 line argument "-q".
2192
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002193zero-warning
2194 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2195 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2196 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2197 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2198 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2199 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002201
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022023.4. Userlists
2203--------------
2204It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2205http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2206it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2207
2208userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002209 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002210 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2211
2212group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002213 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002214 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2215 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2216
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002217user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2218 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002219 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2220 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002221 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2222 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2223 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2224 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002226 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2227 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2228 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2229 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2230 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2231 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2232 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2233 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2234 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002235
2236 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002237 userlist L1
2238 group G1 users tiger,scott
2239 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002241 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2242 user scott insecure-password elgato
2243 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002244
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002245 userlist L2
2246 group G1
2247 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002248
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002249 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2250 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2251 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002252
2253 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002255
22563.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002257----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002258It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2259several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2260instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2261values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2262automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2263In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2264using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2265tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2266reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2267Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2268that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2269each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
2271peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002272 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002273 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2274
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002275bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2276 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2277 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2278
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002279disabled
2280 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2281 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2282 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2283
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002284default-bind [param*]
2285 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2286
2287default-server [param*]
2288 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2289
2290 Arguments:
2291 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2292 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2293 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2294 details.
2295
2296
2297 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2298
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002299enable
2300 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2301
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002302log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2303 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2304 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2305 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2306 more details.
2307
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002308peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002309 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2310 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2311 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2312 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2313 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2314 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2315
2316 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2317 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2318
2319 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2320 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2321 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2322 across all peers.
2323
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002324 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2325 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002326
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002327 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2328 "server" keyword explanation below).
2329
2330server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002331 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002332 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2333 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2334 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2335 of this "peers" section).
2336 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2337
2338
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002339 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002340 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002341 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002342 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2343 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2344 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002345
2346 backend mybackend
2347 mode tcp
2348 balance roundrobin
2349 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2350 stick on src
2351
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002352 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2353 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002354
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 Example:
2356 peers mypeers
2357 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2358 default-server ssl verify none
2359 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2360 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002361
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002362
2363table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2364 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2365
2366 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2367 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002368 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002369 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2370 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2371 "stick-table" keyword).
2372
2373 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2374 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2375 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2376 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2377 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2378 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2379 of the stick-table name as follows:
2380
2381 peers mypeers
2382 peer A ...
2383 peer B ...
2384 table t1 ...
2385
2386 frontend fe1
2387 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2388
2389 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2390 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2391
2392 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2393 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2394 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2395 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2396 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2397 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2398 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2399
2400 peers mypeers
2401 peer A ...
2402 peer B ...
2403 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2404
2405 backend t1
2406 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2407
2408 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2409 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2410 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2411
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024123.6. Mailers
2413------------
2414It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2415If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2416in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2417
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002418mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002419 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2420 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2421
2422mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2423 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2424
2425 Example:
2426 mailers mymailers
2427 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2428 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2429
2430 backend mybackend
2431 mode tcp
2432 balance roundrobin
2433
2434 email-alert mailers mymailers
2435 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2436 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2437
2438 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2439 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2440
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002441timeout mail <time>
2442 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2443 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2444 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2445 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2446
2447 Example:
2448 mailers mymailers
2449 timeout mail 20s
2450 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002451
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024523.7. Programs
2453-------------
2454In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2455master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2456managed the same way as the workers.
2457
2458During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2459sequence as a worker:
2460
2461 - the master is re-executed
2462 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2463 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2464 instance of the program
2465
2466During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2467
2468program <name>
2469 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2470 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2471 the management guide).
2472
2473command <command> [arguments*]
2474 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2475 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2476 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2477 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2478
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002479user <user name>
2480 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2481 See also "group".
2482
2483group <group name>
2484 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2485 See also "user".
2486
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002487option start-on-reload
2488no option start-on-reload
2489 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2490 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2491 program section.
2492
2493
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010024943.8. HTTP-errors
2495----------------
2496
2497It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2498imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2499several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2500
2501http-errors <name>
2502 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2503 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2504
2505errorfile <code> <file>
2506 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2507
2508 Arguments :
2509 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2510 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2511 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2512
2513 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2514 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2515 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2516 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2517 before any chroot is performed.
2518
2519 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2520
2521 Example:
2522 http-errors website-1
2523 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2524 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2525 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2526
2527 http-errors website-2
2528 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2529 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2530 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2531
2532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025334. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002534----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002536Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002537 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002538 - frontend <name>
2539 - backend <name>
2540 - listen <name>
2541
2542A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2543its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2544section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002546
2547A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2548connections.
2549
2550A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2551to forward incoming connections.
2552
2553A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2554parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2557'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2558case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2559
2560Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2561logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2562proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2563However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2564name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2565
2566Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2567and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002568bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2570modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2571arbitrary criteria.
2572
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002573In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2574a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002575the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002576
2577 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2578 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2579 between responses and new requests.
2580
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002581 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2582 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2583 client-facing connection remains open.
2584
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002585 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2586 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002587
2588The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2589frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2590following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002591weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002592
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002593 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002595 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2596 ----+-----+-----+----
2597 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2598 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002599 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2600 ----+-----+-----+----
2601 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026054.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2606--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002608The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2609limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2610they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2611limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002613option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002614and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2615with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2616specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002618
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002619 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2620------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2621acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002622backlog X X X -
2623balance X - X X
2624bind - X X -
2625bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626capture cookie - X X -
2627capture request header - X X -
2628capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002629compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002630cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002631declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002632default-server X - X X
2633default_backend X X X -
2634description - X X X
2635disabled X X X X
2636dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002637email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002638email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002639email-alert mailers X X X X
2640email-alert myhostname X X X X
2641email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002642enabled X X X X
2643errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002644errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002645errorloc X X X X
2646errorloc302 X X X X
2647-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2648errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002649force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002650filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002651fullconn X - X X
2652grace X X X X
2653hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002654http-after-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002656http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002657http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002659http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002660http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002661http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002662id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002663ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002664load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002665log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002666log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002667log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002668log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002669max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002670maxconn X X X -
2671mode X X X X
2672monitor fail - X X -
2673monitor-net X X X -
2674monitor-uri X X X -
2675option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2676option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2677option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2678option allbackups (*) X - X X
2679option checkcache (*) X - X X
2680option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2681option contstats (*) X X X -
2682option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2683option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002684-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2685option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002686option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2687option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002688option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002689option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002690option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002691option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002692option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002693option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2694option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2695option httpchk X - X X
2696option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002697option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002698option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002699option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002700option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002701option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002702option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2703option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2704option logasap (*) X X X -
2705option mysql-check X - X X
2706option nolinger (*) X X X X
2707option originalto X X X X
2708option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002709option pgsql-check X - X X
2710option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002711option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002712option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002713option smtpchk X - X X
2714option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2715option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2716option splice-request (*) X X X X
2717option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002718option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002719option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2720option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2721-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002722option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002723option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2724option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2725option tcpka X X X X
2726option tcplog X X X X
2727option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002728external-check command X - X X
2729external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002730persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2731rate-limit sessions X X X -
2732redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002734retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002735retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002736server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002737server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002738server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002740stats admin - X X X
2741stats auth X X X X
2742stats enable X X X X
2743stats hide-version X X X X
2744stats http-request - X X X
2745stats realm X X X X
2746stats refresh X X X X
2747stats scope X X X X
2748stats show-desc X X X X
2749stats show-legends X X X X
2750stats show-node X X X X
2751stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002752-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2753stick match - - X X
2754stick on - - X X
2755stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002756stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002757stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002758tcp-check connect - - X X
2759tcp-check expect - - X X
2760tcp-check send - - X X
2761tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01002762tcp-check set-var - - X X
2763tcp-check unset-var - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002764tcp-request connection - X X -
2765tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002766tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002767tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002768tcp-response content - - X X
2769tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002770timeout check X - X X
2771timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002772timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002773timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002774timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2775timeout http-request X X X X
2776timeout queue X - X X
2777timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002778timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002779timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002780timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002781transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002782unique-id-format X X X -
2783unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002784use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002785use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002786use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002787------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2788 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2792---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002793
2794This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2795
2796
2797acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2798 Declare or complete an access list.
2799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2800 no | yes | yes | yes
2801 Example:
2802 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2803 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2804 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002806 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002807
2808
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002809backlog <conns>
2810 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2812 yes | yes | yes | no
2813 Arguments :
2814 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2815 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002816 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002817
2818 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2819 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2820 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2821 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2822 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2823 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2824 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2825 backlog parameter.
2826
2827 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2828 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2829 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2830
2831 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2832
2833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002835balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2838 yes | no | yes | yes
2839 Arguments :
2840 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2841 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2842 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2843 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2844
2845 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2846 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2847 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2848 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002849 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002850 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002851 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2852 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2853 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2854 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2855 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2856 it, so that you don't worry.
2857
2858 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2859 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2860 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2861 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2862 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2863 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2864 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2865 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002867 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2868 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2869 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2870 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2871 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2872 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2873 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2874 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2875
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002876 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002877 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002878 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2879 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002880 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002881 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2882 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2883 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2884 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2885 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002886 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2887 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2888 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2889 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2890 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2891 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002892
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002893 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2894 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2895 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2896 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2897 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2898 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2899 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2900 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002901 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002902 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002903 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2904 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2905 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002906
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002907 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2908 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2909 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2910 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2911 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2912 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2913 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2914 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2915 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2916 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2917 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2918 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002920 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002921 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2922 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2923 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2924 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2925 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2926 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2927 URIs start with a leading "/".
2928
2929 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2930 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2931 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2932 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002934 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002935 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2936
2937 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002938 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2939 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002940 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2941 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2942 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2943 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002944 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002945 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2946 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002947
2948 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2949 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2950 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2951 server will receive the request.
2952
2953 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2954 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2955 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2956 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2957 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002958 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2959 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2960 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002962 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2963 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2964 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2965 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2966 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002968 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002969 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2970 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2971 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2972
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002973 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2974 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2975 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2976
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002977 random
2978 random(<draws>)
2979 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002980 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2981 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2982 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2983 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002984 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2985 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2986 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2987 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2988 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2989 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2990 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2991 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2992 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2993 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2994 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2995 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2996 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2997 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2998 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2999 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3000 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3001 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3002 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3003 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003004
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003005 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003006 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003007 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3008 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3009 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3010 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3011 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3012 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003013 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003014 used instead.
3015
3016 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3017 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3018 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3019 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3020
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003021 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3022 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3023 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3024
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003025 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003026
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003027 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003028 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3029 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003030
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003031 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3032 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3033 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003035 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003036 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003037 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3038 NTLM relies on.
3039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040 Examples :
3041 balance roundrobin
3042 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003043 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003044 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3045 balance hdr(host)
3046 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003047
3048 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3049 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003051 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003052 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3053 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3054 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003055 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003056
3057 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3058 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3059 defaults to 16 kB.
3060
3061 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3062 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3063
3064 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3065 Round Robin.
3066
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003067 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003068 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3069 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3070 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3071
3072 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3073
3074 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003075 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003076 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3077 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3078 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003079
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003080 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081
3082
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003083bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3084bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3087 no | yes | yes | no
3088 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003089 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3090 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3091 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3092 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003093 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003094 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3095 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3096 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3097 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3098 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3099 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3100 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003101 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3102 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3103 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3104 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3105 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3106 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3107 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003108 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3109 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3110 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003111 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3112 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3113 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3114 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003115 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3116 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3117 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003118
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003119 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3120 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003121 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3122 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3123 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003124 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3125 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3126 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3127 the range.
3128
3129 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3130 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3131 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3132 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3133 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3134 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3135 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003136 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003137 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003139 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003140 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003141 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3142 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3143 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3144 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3145 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3146 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003148 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3149 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3150 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3151 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003152
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003153 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3154 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3155 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3156 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3157 in a frontend.
3158
3159 Example :
3160 listen http_proxy
3161 bind :80,:443
3162 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003163 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003165 listen http_https_proxy
3166 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003167 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003168
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003169 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3170 bind ipv6@:80
3171 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3172 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3173
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003174 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003175 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003176
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003177 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3178 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3179 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3180 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3181 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3182
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003183 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003184 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185
3186
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003187bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003188 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3190 yes | yes | yes | yes
3191 Arguments :
3192 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3193 may be used to override a default value.
3194
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003195 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003196 option may be combined with other numbers.
3197
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003198 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003199 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3200 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3201 missing from all processes.
3202
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003203 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003204 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003205 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3206 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3207 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3208 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3209 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003210 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003211
3212 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3213 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3214 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3215 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3216 and 'even' instances.
3217
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003218 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3219 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3220 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3221 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003222
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003223 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3224 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3225
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003226 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3227 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3228 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3229
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003230 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3231 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3232
3233 Example :
3234 listen app_ip1
3235 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003236 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003237
3238 listen app_ip2
3239 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003240 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003241
3242 listen management
3243 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003244 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003245
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003246 listen management
3247 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3248 bind-process 1-4
3249
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003250 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003251
3252
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003253capture cookie <name> len <length>
3254 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3256 no | yes | yes | no
3257 Arguments :
3258 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3259 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3260 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3261 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003262 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263
3264 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3265 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3266 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3267 right if it exceeds <length>.
3268
3269 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3270 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3271 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3272 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3273
3274 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3275 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3276 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3277
3278 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3279 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3280 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003281 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3282 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3283 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003284
3285 Example:
3286 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3287
3288 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003289 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003290
3291
3292capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003293 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3295 no | yes | yes | no
3296 Arguments :
3297 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003298 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003299 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3300 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3301 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3302
3303 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3304 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3305 it exceeds <length>.
3306
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003307 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003308 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3309 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003310 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3311 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3312 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3313 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003314 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003315 environments to find where the request came from.
3316
3317 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3318 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3319 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3320 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003321
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003322 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3323 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3324 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3325 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3326 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003327
3328 Example:
3329 capture request header Host len 15
3330 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003331 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003333 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003334 about logging.
3335
3336
3337capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003338 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3340 no | yes | yes | no
3341 Arguments :
3342 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003343 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3345 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3346 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3347
3348 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3349 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3350 it exceeds <length>.
3351
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003352 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003353 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3354 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3355 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003356 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3357 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3358 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3359 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003361 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3362 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3363 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3364 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3365 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366
3367 Example:
3368 capture response header Content-length len 9
3369 capture response header Location len 15
3370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003371 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372 about logging.
3373
3374
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003375compression algo <algorithm> ...
3376compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003377compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003378 Enable HTTP compression.
3379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3380 yes | yes | yes | yes
3381 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003382 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3383 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3384 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3385
3386 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003387 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3388 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3389 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003390
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003391 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003392 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003393
3394 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3395 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3396 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3397 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3398 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003399 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003400
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003401 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3402 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3403 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3404 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3405 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3406 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3407 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003408 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003409
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003410 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003411 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003412 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3413 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3414 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3415 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3416 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003417
3418 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3419 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3420 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3421 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3422 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003423 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3424 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3425 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3426 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3427 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003428 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3429 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003430
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003431 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003432 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3433 "Accept-Encoding" header
3434 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003435 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003436 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3437 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3438 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3439 "multipart"
3440 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3441 header
3442 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3443 and later
3444 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3445 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003446 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003447
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003448 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003449
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003450 Examples :
3451 compression algo gzip
3452 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003453
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003454
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003455cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003456 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3457 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003458 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3461 yes | no | yes | yes
3462 Arguments :
3463 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3464 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3465 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3466 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3467 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3468 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003469 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003470 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3471 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3472
3473 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3474 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3475 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3476 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3477 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3478 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003479 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3480 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003482 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3483 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
3485 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003486 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003487
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003488 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003489 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003490 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003491 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003492 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3493 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3494 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3495 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3496 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3497 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3498 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003499
3500 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3501 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3502 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3503 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3504 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3505 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3506 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3507 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3508 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003509 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003510 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3511 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3512 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003513
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003514 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3515 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3516 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003517 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3518 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3519 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3520 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003521 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3522 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3523 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003524
3525 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3526 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3527 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3528 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3529 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3530 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3531 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3532 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3533 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3534
3535 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3536 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3537 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3538 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3539 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3540 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3541 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3542 persistence cookie in the cache.
3543 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3544
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003545 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3546 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3547 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3548 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3549 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003550 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003551 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3552 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3553 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3554 they logout.
3555
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003556 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3557 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3558 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3559 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3560
3561 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3562 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3563 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3564 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3565 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3566 this attribute.
3567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003568 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003569 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003570 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3571 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3572 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3573 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3574 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3575 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003576
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003577 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3578 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3579 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3580 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3581 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3582 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3583 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3584 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003585 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003586 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3587 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3588 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3589 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3590 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3591 the site.
3592
3593 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3594 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3595 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3596 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3597 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3598 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3599 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3600 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3601 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3602 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3603 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3604 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3605 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003606 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003607 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3608 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3609
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003610 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3611 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3612 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3613 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3614 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3615 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3616
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003617 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3618 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3619 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3620 repeated.
3621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003622 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3623 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3624 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3625 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003627 Examples :
3628 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3629 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3630 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003631 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003633 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003635
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003636declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3637 Declares a capture slot.
3638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3639 no | yes | yes | no
3640 Arguments:
3641 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3642
3643 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3644 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3645 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3646 for use in the response.
3647
3648 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003649 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003650 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3651
3652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003653default-server [param*]
3654 Change default options for a server in a backend
3655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3656 yes | no | yes | yes
3657 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003658 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3659 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3660 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3661 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003662
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003663 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003664 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3665
3666 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669default_backend <backend>
3670 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3672 yes | yes | yes | no
3673 Arguments :
3674 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3675
3676 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3677 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3678 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3679 will catch all undetermined requests.
3680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003681 Example :
3682
3683 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3684 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3685 default_backend dynamic
3686
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003687 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003688
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003690description <string>
3691 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3693 no | yes | yes | yes
3694 Arguments : string
3695
3696 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3697 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3698 it describes.
3699 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3700
3701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003702disabled
3703 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | yes
3706 Arguments : none
3707
3708 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3709 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3710 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3711 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3712 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3713 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3714 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3715
3716 See also : "enabled"
3717
3718
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003719dispatch <address>:<port>
3720 Set a default server address
3721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3722 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003723 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003724
3725 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3726 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3727 during start-up.
3728
3729 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3730 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3731 possible with normal servers.
3732
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003733 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003734 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3735 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3736 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3737 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3738
3739 See also : "server"
3740
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003741
3742dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3743 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3745 yes | no | yes | yes
3746 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3747
3748 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003749 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003750 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3751 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003752 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003753 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003754
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003755enabled
3756 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3758 yes | yes | yes | yes
3759 Arguments : none
3760
3761 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3762 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3763
3764 See also : "disabled"
3765
3766
3767errorfile <code> <file>
3768 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3770 yes | yes | yes | yes
3771 Arguments :
3772 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003773 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3774 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
3776 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003777 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003778 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003779 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3780 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3783 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3784 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3785
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003786 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003788 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3789 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3790 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3791 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3792
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003793 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3794 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003795 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003796 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3797 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3798 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003800 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3801 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3802 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003803 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003804 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3805
3806 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3807
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003808 Example :
3809 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003810 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003811 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3812 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3813
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003814
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003815errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3816 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3817 section.
3818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3819 yes | yes | yes | yes
3820 Arguments :
3821 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3822
3823 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3824 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3825 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3826
3827 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3828 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3829 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3830 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3831 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3832 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3833 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3834
3835 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3836 3.8 about http-errors.
3837
3838 Example :
3839 errorfiles generic
3840 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3841
3842
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003843errorloc <code> <url>
3844errorloc302 <code> <url>
3845 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 yes | yes | yes | yes
3848 Arguments :
3849 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003850 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3851 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003852
3853 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3854 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3855 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3856 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003857 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003858
3859 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3860 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3861 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3862
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003863 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3864
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003865 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3866 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3867 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3868 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003869 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003870 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3871 request.
3872
3873 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3874
3875
3876errorloc303 <code> <url>
3877 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | yes | yes | yes
3880 Arguments :
3881 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003882 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3883 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003884
3885 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3886 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3887 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3888 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003889 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003890
3891 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3892 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3893 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3894
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003895 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3896
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003897 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3898 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3899 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3900 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003901 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003902
3903 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3904
3905
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003906email-alert from <emailaddr>
3907 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003908 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3910 yes | yes | yes | yes
3911
3912 Arguments :
3913
3914 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3915
3916 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3917 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3918
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003919 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003920 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3921 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003922
3923
3924email-alert level <level>
3925 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3926 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | yes
3929
3930 Arguments :
3931
3932 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3933 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3934 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3935
3936 By default level is alert
3937
3938 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3939 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3940 for the proxy.
3941
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003942 Alerts are sent when :
3943
3944 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3945 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3946 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3947 is notice or lower
3948 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3949 and a health check status update occurs
3950
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003951 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3952 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003953 section 3.6 about mailers.
3954
3955
3956email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3957 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3958 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3959 yes | yes | yes | yes
3960
3961 Arguments :
3962
3963 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3964
3965 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3966 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3967
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003968 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3969 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003970
3971
3972email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3973 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3974 mailers.
3975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3976 yes | yes | yes | yes
3977
3978 Arguments :
3979
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003980 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003981
3982 By default the systems hostname is used.
3983
3984 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3985 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3986 for the proxy.
3987
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003988 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3989 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003990
3991
3992email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003993 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003994 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | yes | yes | yes
3997
3998 Arguments :
3999
4000 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4001
4002 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4003 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4004
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004005 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004006 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4007
4008
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004009force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4010 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004012 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004013
4014 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4015 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4016 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4017 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4018 marked down for maintenance operations.
4019
4020 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4021 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4022 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4023 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4024 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4025 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4026 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4027 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4028 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4029
4030 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4031 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4032 is used.
4033
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004034 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004035 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004036
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004037
4038filter <name> [param*]
4039 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 no | yes | yes | yes
4042 Arguments :
4043 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4044 referenced in section 9.
4045
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004046 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004047 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004048 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4049 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004050
4051 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4052 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4053
4054 Example:
4055 listen
4056 bind *:80
4057
4058 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4059 filter compression
4060 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4061
4062 compression algo gzip
4063 compression offload
4064
4065 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4066
4067 See also : section 9.
4068
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004069
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004070fullconn <conns>
4071 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4073 yes | no | yes | yes
4074 Arguments :
4075 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4076 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4077
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004078 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004079 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004080 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004081 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4082 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4083 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4084 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4085 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004086 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004087
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004088 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4089 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004090 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4091 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4092 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004093
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004094 Example :
4095 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4096 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4097 # connections.
4098 backend dynamic
4099 fullconn 10000
4100 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4101 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4102
4103 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4104
4105
4106grace <time>
4107 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004109 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004110 Arguments :
4111 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4112 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4113 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4114
4115 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4116 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004117 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004118 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4119
4120 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4121 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4122 simplify it.
4123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004124
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004125hash-balance-factor <factor>
4126 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4128 yes | no | no | yes
4129 Arguments :
4130 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4131 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004132 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004133
4134 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4135 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4136 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4137 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4138 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4139 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4140 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4141
4142 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4143 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4144 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4145 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4146 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4147
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004148 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4149 consistent hashing mechanism.
4150
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004151 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4152
4153
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004154hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004155 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4157 yes | no | yes | yes
4158 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004159 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4160 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004161
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004162 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4163 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4164 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4165 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4166 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4167 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4168 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4169 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4170 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4171 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004172
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004173 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4174 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4175 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4176 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4177 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4178 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4179 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4180 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4181 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4182 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4183 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4184 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4185 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004186 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4187 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004188
4189 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4190
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004191 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004192 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4193 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4194 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004195 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4196 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4197 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004198
4199 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4200 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004201 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4202 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4203 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4204 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4205
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004206 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4207 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4208 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4209 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4210 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4211 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4212 parameter.
4213
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004214 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4215 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4216 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4217 used on strings.
4218
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004219 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4220
4221 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4222 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4223 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4224 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4225 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4226 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4227 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4228 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4229 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4230 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4231 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4232 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004233
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004234 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4235 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4236 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004237
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004238 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004239
4240
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004241http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4242 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4243 ones).
4244
4245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 no | yes | yes | yes
4247
4248 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4249 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4250 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4251 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4252 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4253 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4254
4255 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4256 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4257 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4258
4259 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4260 below.
4261
4262 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4263 instance.
4264
4265 Example:
4266 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4267 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4268 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4269
4270http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4271
4272 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4273 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4274 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4275 example, or to pass some internal information.
4276 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4277 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4278 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4279
4280http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4281
4282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4283 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4284
4285http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4286
4287 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4288
4289http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4290 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4291
4292 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4293
4294 Example:
4295 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4296
4297 # applied to:
4298 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4299
4300 # outputs:
4301 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4302
4303 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4304
4305http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4306 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4307
4308 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4309
4310 Example:
4311 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4312
4313 # applied to:
4314 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4315
4316 # outputs:
4317 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4318
4319http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4320
4321 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4322 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4323 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4324
4325http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4326 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4327
4328 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4329 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4330 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4331 fallback.
4332
4333 Example:
4334 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4335 http-response set-status 431
4336 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4337 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4338
4339http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4340
4341 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4342 inline.
4343
4344 Arguments:
4345 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4346 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4347 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4348 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4349 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4350 (request and response)
4351 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4352 processing
4353 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4354 processing
4355 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4356 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4357 and '_'.
4358
4359 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4360 followed by some converters.
4361
4362 Example:
4363 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4364
4365http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4366
4367 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4368 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4369 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4370 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4371 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004372 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004373 processing.
4374
4375 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4376 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4377 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4378 rules evaluation.
4379
4380http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4381
4382 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4383 details about <var-name>.
4384
4385 Example:
4386 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4387
4388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004389http-check disable-on-404
4390 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004392 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004393 Arguments : none
4394
4395 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4396 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4397 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4398 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4399 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4400 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4401 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4402 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004403 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4404 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4405 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4406
4407 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4408
4409
4410http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004411 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004413 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004414 Arguments :
4415 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4416 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004417 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004418 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4419 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4420 details on the supported keywords.
4421
4422 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4423 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4424 with the usual backslash ('\').
4425
4426 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4427 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4428 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4429 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4430 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4431
4432 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004433 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004434 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4435 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4436 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4437
4438 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004439 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004440 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4441 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4442 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4443 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4444
4445 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004446 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004447 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4448 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4449 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4450 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4451 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004452 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004453 trace).
4454
4455 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004456 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004457 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4458 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4459 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4460 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4461 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004462 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004463
4464 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4465 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4466 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4467 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4468 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4469 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4470 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4471 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4472
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004473 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4474 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4475 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4476
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004477 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4478 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4479
4480 Examples :
4481 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004482 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004483
4484 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004485 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004486
4487 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004488 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004489
4490 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004491 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004492
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004493 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004494
4495
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004496http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4497 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4498 health checks.
4499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4500 yes | no | yes | yes
4501 Arguments :
4502 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4503 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4504 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4505
4506 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4507 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4508 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4509 to the request.
4510
4511 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4512 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4513 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4514 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4515 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4516 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4517 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4518 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4519
4520 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4521
4522
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004523http-check send-state
4524 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4526 yes | no | yes | yes
4527 Arguments : none
4528
4529 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4530 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4531 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4532 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4533 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4534
4535 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4536 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4537 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4538 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4539 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004540 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4541 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4542 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4543
4544 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4545 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4546 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4547
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004548 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4549 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4550 checked in multiple backends.
4551
4552 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4553 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4554
4555 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4556 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4557 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4558 one fails.
4559
4560 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4561 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4562 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4563
4564 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4565 server's queue.
4566
4567 Example of a header received by the application server :
4568 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4569 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4570
4571 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004573
4574http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004575 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4576
4577 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4578 no | yes | yes | yes
4579
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004580 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4581 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4582 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4583 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4584 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004586 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4587 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004589 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591 Example:
4592 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4593 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4594 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004596 http-request allow if nagios
4597 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4598 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4599 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601 Example:
4602 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4603 acl add path /addacl
4604 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4609 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611 Example:
4612 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4613 acl setmap path /setmap
4614 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4619 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004621 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4622 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004624http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004626 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4627 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4628 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4629 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4630 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4631 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4632 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4633 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004635http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4638 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4639 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4640 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4641 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4642 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4643 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4644 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4649 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004650
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4655 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4656 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4657 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4658 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004660 Example:
4661 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4662 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004663
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004664http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004665
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004666 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4669 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004671 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4672 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4673 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4674 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4675 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4676 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4677 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4678 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4679 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004681 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4682 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4683 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004684 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4685
4686 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4687 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4688 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4689 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004691http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4694 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4695 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4696 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4697 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4698 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004700http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004702 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004704http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004706 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4707 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4708 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4709 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4710 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4711 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004712
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004713http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4714 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4717 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4718 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004719 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4720 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4721 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4722 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4723 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004724 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004725
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004726http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4727 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4728 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4729 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4730
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004731http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4732
4733 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4734 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4735 pointed by <resolvers>.
4736 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4737 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4738 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4739 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4740 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4741 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4742 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4743 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4744 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4745 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4746 to 0.0.0.0.
4747
4748 Example:
4749 resolvers mydns
4750 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4751 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4752 timeout retry 1s
4753 hold valid 10s
4754 hold nx 3s
4755 hold other 3s
4756 hold obsolete 0s
4757 accepted_payload_size 8192
4758
4759 frontend fe
4760 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4761 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4762 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4763
4764 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4765 # which mean DNS resolution error
4766 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4767
4768 default_backend be
4769
4770 backend b_503
4771 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4772 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4773 # 503 error page to end users
4774
4775 backend be
4776 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4777 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4778 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4779 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4780 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4781
4782 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4783 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4784
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004785http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4786
4787 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4788 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4789 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4790 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004791 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4792 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004793
4794 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004796http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004798 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4799 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4800 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4801 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4802 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004804http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004805
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004806 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4807 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4808 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4809 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004811http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4812 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004813
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004814 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004815 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4816 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4817 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4818 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4819 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004820
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004821 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4822 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4823 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4824 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4825 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004826
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004827 Example:
4828 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4829
4830 # applied to:
4831 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4832
4833 # outputs:
4834 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4835
4836 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004837
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004838 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4839
4840 # applied to:
4841 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004842
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004843 # outputs:
4844 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004845
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004846http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4847 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4848
4849 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4850 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4851 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4852 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4853
4854 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4855 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4856 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4857
4858 Example:
4859 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4860 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4861
4862 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4863 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4864
4865 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4866 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4867 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4868 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4869
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004870http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4871 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4872
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004873 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4874 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4875 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4876 against.
4877
4878 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4879 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4880 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004881
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004882 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4883 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4884 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4885 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4886 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4887 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4888 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4889 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4890 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004891 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4892 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004893
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004894 Example:
4895 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4896 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004897
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004898 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4899 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004901http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4902 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004903
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004904 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4905 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4906 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4907 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004908
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004909 Example:
4910 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004911
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004912 # applied to:
4913 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004914
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004915 # outputs:
4916 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004917
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004918http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
4919 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4920 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004921 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004922 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4923
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004924 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004925 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
4926 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
4927 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
4928 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004929 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004930 are followed to create the response :
4931
4932 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
4933 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
4934 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4935 ignored.
4936
4937 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
4938 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
4939 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
4940 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
4941 ignored.
4942
4943 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
4944 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
4945 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
4946 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
4947 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
4948
4949 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
4950 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
4951 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
4952 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
4953 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
4954 if any, is ignored.
4955
4956 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
4957 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
4958 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
4959 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
4960 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
4961 as a raw content.
4962
4963 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
4964 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
4965 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
4966 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
4967 considered as a raw string.
4968
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01004969 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
4970 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
4971 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
4972 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
4973
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01004974 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
4975 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
4976 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
4977
4978 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4979
4980 Example:
4981 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
4982 if { path /ping }
4983
4984 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
4985 if { path /favicon.ico }
4986
4987 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
4988 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
4989 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
4990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004991http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4992http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004994 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4995 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4996 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004997
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004998http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005000
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005001 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5002 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5003 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5004 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005006http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005008 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5009 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5010 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5011 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5012 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014 Arguments:
5015 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5016 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005018 Example:
5019 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5020 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005022 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5023 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005024
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005025http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005027 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5028 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5029 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005031 Arguments:
5032 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5033 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005035 Example:
5036 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5037 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005039 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5040 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5041 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005043http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005045 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5046 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5047 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5048 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5049 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005051 Example:
5052 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5053 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5054 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5055 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5056 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5057 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5058 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5059 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5060 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005062http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005063
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005064 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5065 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5066 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5067 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5068 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005070http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5071 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005073 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5074 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5075 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5076 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5077 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5078 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5079 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5080 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5081 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005083http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005085 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5086 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5087 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5088 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5089 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5090 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5091 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005093http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005095 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5096 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5097 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005099http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005101 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5102 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5103 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5104 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5105 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5106 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5107 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5108 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005110http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005111
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005112 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5113 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5114 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5115 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5116 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5117 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005119 Example :
5120 # prepend the host name before the path
5121 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005123http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005125 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5126 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5127 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5128 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5129 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005131http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005132
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005133 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5134 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5135 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5136 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5137 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5138 values have higher priority.
5139 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5140 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5141 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5142 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5143 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005145http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005147 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5148 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5149 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5150 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5151 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5152 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5153 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005155 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005156
5157 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005158 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5159 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005161http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5162 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5163 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5164 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005165 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5166 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005167
5168 Arguments :
5169 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5170 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005171
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005172 See also "option forwardfor".
5173
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005174 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005175 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5176 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5177
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005178 # After the masking this will track connections
5179 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5180 http-request track-sc0 src
5181
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005182 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5183 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5184
5185http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5186
5187 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5188 expression.
5189
5190 Arguments:
5191 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5192 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005193
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005194 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005195 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5196 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5197
5198 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5199 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5200 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5201
5202http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5203
5204 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5205 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5206 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5207 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5208 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5209 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5210 information from the request.
5211
5212 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5213
5214http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5215
5216 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5217 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5218 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5219 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5220 path and the query string.
5221 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5222
5223http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224
5225 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5226 inline.
5227
5228 Arguments:
5229 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5230 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5231 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5232 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5233 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5234 (request and response)
5235 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5236 processing
5237 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5238 processing
5239 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5240 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5241 and '_'.
5242
5243 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5244 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005245
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005246 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005247 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005249http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005252 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5253 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5254 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5255 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5256 agent name must be used.
5257
5258 Arguments:
5259 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5260
5261 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5262 configuration.
5263
5264http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5265
5266 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5267 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5268 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5269 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5270 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5271 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5272 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5273 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5274 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5275 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5276 action.
5277 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5278 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5279 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5280 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5281 you fully understand how it works.
5282
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005283http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5284
5285 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5286 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5287 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5288 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5289 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005290 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005291 processing.
5292
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005293 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005294 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5295 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5296 rules evaluation.
5297
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005298http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5299 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005300
5301 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5302 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5303 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
5304 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
5305 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
5306 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
5307 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
5308 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
5309 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
5310 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
5311 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005312 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
5313 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5314 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5315 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5316 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005317 See also the "silent-drop" action.
5318
5319http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5320http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5321http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5322
5323 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5324 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5325 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5326 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5327 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5328 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5329 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5330 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5331 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5332 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5333 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5334 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5335
5336 Arguments :
5337 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5338 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5339 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5340 select which table entry to update the counters.
5341
5342 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5343 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5344 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5345 that table until the session ends.
5346
5347 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5348 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5349 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5350 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5351 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5352 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5353 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5354 useful information.
5355
5356 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5357 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5358 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5359 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5360 checks that make use of it.
5361
5362http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5363
5364 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005365
5366 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005367 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005368
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005369http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5370
5371 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5372 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5373 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5374 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5375 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5376 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5377
5378 Arguments :
5379 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5380
5381 Example:
5382 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005384http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005386 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5387 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5388 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005389
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005391http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005392 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5393
5394 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5395 no | yes | yes | yes
5396
5397 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5398 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5399 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5400 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5401 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5402 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5403
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005404 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5405 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005406
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005407 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005408
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005409 Example:
5410 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005411
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005412 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005413
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005414 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5415 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005417 Example:
5418 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005420 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005422 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5423 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005424
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005425 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5426 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005428http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005430 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5431 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5432 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5433 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5434 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5435 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5436 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5437 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005439http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005440
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005441 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5442 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5443 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5444 example, or to pass some internal information.
5445 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5446 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5447 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005448
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005449http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005450
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005451 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5452 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005453
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005454http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005455
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005456 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005457
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005458http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005460 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5461 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5462 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5463 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5464 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5465 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5466 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005467
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005468 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5469 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5470 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5471 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5472 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005473
5474 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5475 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5476 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5477 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005478
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005479http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005480
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005481 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5482 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5483 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5484 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5485 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5486 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005487
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005488http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005490 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005492http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005493
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005494 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5495 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5496 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5497 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5498 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5499 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005500
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005501http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5502 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005503
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005504 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005505 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5506 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005507 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5508 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5509 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5510 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5511 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005512 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005513
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005514http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005515
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005516 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5517 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5518 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5519 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5520 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5521 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005522
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005523http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5524 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005525
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005526 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5527 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005528
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005529 Example:
5530 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005531
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005532 # applied to:
5533 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005534
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005535 # outputs:
5536 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005537
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005538 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005539
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005540http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5541 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005542
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005543 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005544 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005545
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005546 Example:
5547 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005548
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005549 # applied to:
5550 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005551
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005552 # outputs:
5553 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005554
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005555http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5556 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5557 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005558 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005559 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5560
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005561 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005562 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5563 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5564 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5565 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005566 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005567 are followed to create the response :
5568
5569 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5570 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5571 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5572 ignored.
5573
5574 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5575 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5576 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5577 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5578 ignored.
5579
5580 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5581 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5582 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5583 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5584 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5585
5586 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5587 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5588 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5589 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5590 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5591 if any, is ignored.
5592
5593 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5594 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5595 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5596 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5597 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5598 as a raw content.
5599
5600 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5601 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5602 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5603 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5604 considered as a raw string.
5605
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005606 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5607 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5608 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5609 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5610
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005611 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5612 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5613 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5614
5615 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
5616
5617 Example:
5618 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5619 if { status eq 404 }
5620
5621 http-response return content-type text/plain \
5622 string "This is the end !" \
5623 if { status eq 500 }
5624
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005625http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5626http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005627
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005628 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5629 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5630 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005631
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005632http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5633 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005634
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005635 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5636 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5637 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5638 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005639
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005640http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005641
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005642 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5643 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5644 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5645 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5646 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005647
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005648 Arguments:
5649 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005650
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005651 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5652 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005653
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005654http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005655
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005656 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5657 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5658 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005659
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005660http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5661
5662 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5663 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5664 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5665 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5666 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5667
5668http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5669
5670 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5671 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5672 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5673 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5674 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5675 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5676 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5677 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5678 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5679
5680http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5681
5682 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5683 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5684 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5685 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5686 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5687 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5688 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5689
5690http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5691
5692 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5693 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5694 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5695 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5696 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5697 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5698 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5699 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5700
5701http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5702 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5703
5704 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5705 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5706 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5707 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005708
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005709 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005710 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5711 http-response set-status 431
5712 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5713 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005715http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005717 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5718 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5719 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5720 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5721 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5722 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5723 based on some information from the request.
5724
5725 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5726
5727http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5728
5729 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5730 inline.
5731
5732 Arguments:
5733 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5734 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5735 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5736 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5737 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5738 (request and response)
5739 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5740 processing
5741 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5742 processing
5743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5744 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5745 and '_'.
5746
5747 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5748 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005749
5750 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005751 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005753http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005754
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005755 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5756 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5757 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5758 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5759 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5760 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5761 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5762 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5763 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5764 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5765 action.
5766 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5767 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5768 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5769 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5770 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005771
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005772http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5773
5774 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5775 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5776 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5777 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5778 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005779 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005780 processing.
5781
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005782 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005783 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5784 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5785 rules evaluation.
5786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005787http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5788http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5789http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005791 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5792 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5793 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5794 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5795 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5796 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5797
5798http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5799
5800 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5801 about <var-name>.
5802
5803 Example:
5804 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5805
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005806
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005807http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5808 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5809
5810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5811 yes | no | yes | yes
5812
5813 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005814 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5815 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5816 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005817
5818 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5819
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005820 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5821 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5822 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5823 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5824 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5825 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5826 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5827 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5828 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5829 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005830
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005831 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5832 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5833 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5834 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5835 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5836 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5837 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5838 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005839
5840 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5841 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5842 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5843 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5844 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5845 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5846 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5847 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005848 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005849 downsides of rare connection failures.
5850
5851 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5852 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5853 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5854 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5855 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5856 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005857 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005858 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5859 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5860 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5861 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5862 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5863
5864 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005865 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5866 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5867 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005868
5869 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005870 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005871
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005872 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5873 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005874
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005875 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005876
5877 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5878 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5879 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5880
5881 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5882
5883
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005884http-send-name-header [<header>]
5885 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005888 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005889 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5890
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005891 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5892 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5893 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5894 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5895 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5896 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5897 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5898 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5899 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5900 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5901 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5902 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5903 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5904 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5905 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5906 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005907
5908 See also : "server"
5909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005910id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005911 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5913 no | yes | yes | yes
5914 Arguments : none
5915
5916 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5917 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5918 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005919
5920
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005921ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5922 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5923 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005924 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005925
5926 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5927 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5928 and running).
5929
5930 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5931 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5932 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005933 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005934 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5935
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005936 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5937 "unless" condition is met.
5938
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005939 Example:
5940 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5941 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5942 ignore-persist if url_static
5943
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005944 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5945
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005946load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5947 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5949 yes | no | yes | yes
5950
5951 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5952 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5953 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005954 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005955 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5956 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5957 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5958 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5959
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005960 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005961 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005962 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005963
5964 Arguments:
5965 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5966 named "server-state-file".
5967
5968 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5969 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5970 name is used as a file name.
5971
5972 none don't load any stat for this backend
5973
5974 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005975 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5976 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5977 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005978 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005979 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005980
5981 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5982 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5983
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005984 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005985
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005986 global
5987 stats socket /tmp/socket
5988 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005989
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005990 defaults
5991 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005992
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005993 backend bk
5994 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5995 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005996
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005997
5998 Then one can run :
5999
6000 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6001
6002 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6003
6004 1
6005 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6006 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6007 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6008
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006009 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006010
6011 global
6012 stats socket /tmp/socket
6013 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6014
6015 defaults
6016 load-server-state-from-file local
6017
6018 backend bk
6019 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6020 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6021
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006022
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006023 Then one can run :
6024
6025 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6026
6027 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6028
6029 1
6030 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6031 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6032 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6033
6034 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6035 "show servers state"
6036
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006037
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006038log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006039log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6040 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006041no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006042 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6044 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006045
6046 Prefix :
6047 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6048 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6049 prefix does not allow arguments.
6050
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006051 Arguments :
6052 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6053 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6054 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6055 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6056 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6057 parameter.
6058
6059 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6060 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6061
6062 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6063 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6064 standard syslog port).
6065
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006066 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6067 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6068 standard syslog port).
6069
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006070 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6071 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6072 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006073 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006074
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006075 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6076 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6077 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6078 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6079 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6080 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6081 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6082 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6083 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6084 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6085 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6086 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6087 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6088 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6089 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6090 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006091 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6092 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006093
6094 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6095 and "fd@2", see above.
6096
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006097 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6098 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6099 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6100 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6101 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6102 having the logs instantly available.
6103
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006104 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6105 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006106
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006107 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6108 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6109 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6110 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6111 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6112 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6113 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6114 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6115 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6116 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006117 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006118
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006119 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6120 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6121 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6122 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6123 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6124
6125 <sample_size>
6126 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6127 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6128 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6129 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6130 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6131
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006132 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6133 one of the following :
6134
6135 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6136 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6137
6138 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6139 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6140
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006141 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6142 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6143 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6144 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6145 systemd logger consumes.
6146
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006147 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6148 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6149 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6150 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6151
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006152 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6153
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006154 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6155 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6156 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6157
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006158 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6159 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6160 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6161 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006162
6163 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6164 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6165 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006166 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6167 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6168 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6169 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6170 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006171
6172 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6173
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006174 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6175 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6176 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006177
6178 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6179 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6180 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6181 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6182
6183 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6184 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006185
6186 Example :
6187 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006188 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6189 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6190 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006191 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6192 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006193 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006194
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006195
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006196log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006197 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6198 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6199 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006200
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006201 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6202 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6203 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6204 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6205 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006206
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006207 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6208 "option httplog" directives.
6209
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006210log-format-sd <string>
6211 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6213 yes | yes | yes | no
6214
6215 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6216 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6217 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6218 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6219 which covers the log format string in depth.
6220
6221 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6222 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6223
6224 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6225 log format to "rfc5424".
6226
6227 Example :
6228 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6229
6230
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006231log-tag <string>
6232 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | yes | yes | yes
6235
6236 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6237 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6238 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6239 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6240 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6241 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6242 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6243 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6244 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006245
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006246max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6247 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6249 yes | no | yes | yes
6250
6251 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6252 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6253 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6254 servers.
6255
6256 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6257 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6258 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6259 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6260 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006261 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006262 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6263 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6264 picking a different server.
6265
6266 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6267 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6268 even if they have to be queued.
6269
6270 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6271 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6272
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006273max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6274 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6275 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6276 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006277
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006278maxconn <conns>
6279 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6281 yes | yes | yes | no
6282 Arguments :
6283 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6284 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6285 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6286 closes.
6287
6288 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6289 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6290 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6291 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006292 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6293 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6294 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6295 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006296
6297 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6298 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6299 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6300
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006301 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6302 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006304 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6305
6306
6307mode { tcp|http|health }
6308 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6310 yes | yes | yes | yes
6311 Arguments :
6312 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6313 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6314 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6315 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6316
6317 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6318 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6319 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6320 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6321 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6322
6323 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006324 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6325 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6326 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6327 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6328 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6329 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6330 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006331
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006332 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6333 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6334 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006335
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006336 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006337 defaults http_instances
6338 mode http
6339
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006340 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006342
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006343monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006344 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6346 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006347 Arguments :
6348 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6349 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006350 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006351 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6352 backend and its backup.
6353
6354 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6355 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6356 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6357 servers in a list of backends.
6358
6359 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6360 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6361 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6362 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6363 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6364 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6365 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006366 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6367 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006368
6369 Example:
6370 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006371 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006372 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6373 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6374 monitor-uri /site_alive
6375 monitor fail if site_dead
6376
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006377 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006378
6379
6380monitor-net <source>
6381 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6383 yes | yes | yes | no
6384 Arguments :
6385 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6386 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6387 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6388 followed by a mask.
6389
6390 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6391 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006392 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006393 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6394
6395 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6396 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6397 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6398 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006399 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6400 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6401 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006402
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006403 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6404 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6405 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6406 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6407 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6408 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006409
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006410 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6411 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006412
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006413 Example :
6414 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6415 frontend www
6416 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6417
6418 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6419
6420
6421monitor-uri <uri>
6422 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6424 yes | yes | yes | no
6425 Arguments :
6426 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6427 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6428
6429 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6430 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6431 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6432 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6433 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6434 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6435 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6436 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6437
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006438 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006439 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6440 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6441 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6442 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6443 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6444 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006445
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006446 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6447 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6448 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6449 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6450
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006451 Example :
6452 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6453 frontend www
6454 mode http
6455 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6456
6457 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006459
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006460option abortonclose
6461no option abortonclose
6462 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | no | yes | yes
6465 Arguments : none
6466
6467 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6468 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6469 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6470 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006471 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006472 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6473 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6474 encountered while delivering the response.
6475
6476 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6477 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6478 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6479 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6480 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6481 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006482 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006483 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006484 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006485 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6486 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6487 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006489 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6490 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006491 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6492 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6493 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6494 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6495 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6496 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006497 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006498
6499 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6500 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6501
6502 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6503
6504
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006505option accept-invalid-http-request
6506no option accept-invalid-http-request
6507 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6509 yes | yes | yes | no
6510 Arguments : none
6511
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006512 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006513 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006514 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006515 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6516 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6517 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6518 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6519 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006520 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6521 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6522 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6523 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006524 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006525 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006526 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6527 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6528 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006529
6530 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6531 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6532 been confirmed.
6533
6534 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6535 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006536 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6537 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006538 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6539
6540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6542
6543 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6544 stats socket.
6545
6546
6547option accept-invalid-http-response
6548no option accept-invalid-http-response
6549 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | no | yes | yes
6552 Arguments : none
6553
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006554 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006555 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006556 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006557 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6558 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6559 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6560 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6561 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006562 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6563 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6564 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006565
6566 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6567 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6568 been confirmed.
6569
6570 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6571 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6572 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6573 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6574
6575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6577
6578 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6579 stats socket.
6580
6581
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006582option allbackups
6583no option allbackups
6584 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6586 yes | no | yes | yes
6587 Arguments : none
6588
6589 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6590 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6591 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6592 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6593 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6594 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6595 order between the backup servers anymore.
6596
6597 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6598 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6599
6600 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6601 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6602
6603
6604option checkcache
6605no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006606 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6608 yes | no | yes | yes
6609 Arguments : none
6610
6611 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6612 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006613 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006614 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6615 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006616 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006617
6618 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006619 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006620 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006621 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6622 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006623 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006624 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006625 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6626 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006627 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006628 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6629 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006630 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006631 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6632 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6633 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6634 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6635 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6636 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6637 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6638 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6639 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6640
6641 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006642 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6643 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6644 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6645 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006646
6647 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6648 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006649 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006650 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006651
6652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6654
6655
6656option clitcpka
6657no option clitcpka
6658 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6660 yes | yes | yes | no
6661 Arguments : none
6662
6663 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6664 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006665 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006666 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6667
6668 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6669 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6670 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6671 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6672
6673 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6674 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6675 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6676 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6677 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6678
6679 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6680
6681 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6682 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6683 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6684
6685 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6686 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6687
6688 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6689
6690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006691option contstats
6692 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 yes | yes | yes | no
6695 Arguments : none
6696
6697 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6698 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6699 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6700 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006701 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6702 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6703 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6704 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6705 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006706
6707
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006708option dontlog-normal
6709no option dontlog-normal
6710 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 yes | yes | yes | no
6713 Arguments : none
6714
6715 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6716 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6717 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6718 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6719 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6720 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6721 logged.
6722
6723 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6724 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6725 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006727 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006728 logging.
6729
6730
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006731option dontlognull
6732no option dontlognull
6733 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6735 yes | yes | yes | no
6736 Arguments : none
6737
6738 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6739 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6740 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6741 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6742 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6743 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006744 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6745 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6746 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006747
6748 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006749 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006750 would not be logged.
6751
6752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6754
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006755 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6756 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006757
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006758
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006759option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006760 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6762 yes | yes | yes | yes
6763 Arguments :
6764 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6765 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006766 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006767 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006768
6769 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6770 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6771 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6772 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6773 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6774 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6775 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006776 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6777 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6778 possible that the client has already brought one.
6779
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006780 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006781 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006782 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006783 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006784 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006785 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006786
6787 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6788 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6789 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6790 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6791 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6792 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6793 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6794
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006795 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6796 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6797 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6798 are under the control of the end-user.
6799
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006800 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006801 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6802 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006803 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6804 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6805 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006806
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006807 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006808 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6809 frontend www
6810 mode http
6811 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6812
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006813 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6814 backend www
6815 mode http
6816 option forwardfor header X-Client
6817
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006818 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006819 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006820
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006821
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006822option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6823no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6824 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6826 yes | yes | yes | no
6827 Arguments : none
6828
6829 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6830 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6831 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6832 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6833 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6834 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6835 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6836
6837 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6838 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6839 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6840 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6841 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6842 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6843 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6844 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6845 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6846 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6847
6848 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6849
6850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6852
6853 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6854 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6855
6856
6857option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6858no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6859 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6861 yes | no | yes | yes
6862 Arguments : none
6863
6864 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6865 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6866 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6867 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6868 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6869 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6870 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6871
6872 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6873 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6874 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6875 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6876 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6877 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6878 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6879 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6880 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6881 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6882
6883 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6884
6885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6887
6888 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6889 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6890
6891
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006892option http-buffer-request
6893no option http-buffer-request
6894 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 yes | yes | yes | yes
6897 Arguments : none
6898
6899 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6900 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6901 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6902 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6903 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6904 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006905 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6906 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6907 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6908 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006909
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006910 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006911
6912
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006913option http-ignore-probes
6914no option http-ignore-probes
6915 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6917 yes | yes | yes | no
6918 Arguments : none
6919
6920 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6921 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6922 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6923 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6924 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6925 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6926 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6927 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6928 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006929 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6930 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006931 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6932
6933 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6934 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6935 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6936 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6937 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6938 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6939 are often the only way to detect them.
6940
6941 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6942 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6943
6944 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6945
6946
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006947option http-keep-alive
6948no option http-keep-alive
6949 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 yes | yes | yes | yes
6952 Arguments : none
6953
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006954 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6955 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006956 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6957 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006958 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6959 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6960 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006961
6962 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6963 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006964 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6965 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6966 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6967 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6968 situations where this option may be useful :
6969
6970 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006971 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006972
6973 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6974 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6975
6976 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6977 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6978 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6979 request.
6980
6981 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6982 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006983 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6984 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6985 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006986
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006987 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6988 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6989 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6990 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6991 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6992 not set.
6993
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006994 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6995 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6996 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006997
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006998 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006999 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007000 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007001
7002
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007003option http-no-delay
7004no option http-no-delay
7005 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7007 yes | yes | yes | yes
7008 Arguments : none
7009
7010 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7011 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7012 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7013 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7014 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7015 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7016 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7017 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7018 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7019 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7020 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7021 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7022 affected.
7023
7024 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7025 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7026 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7027 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7028 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7029 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7030 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7031 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7032 latency environments.
7033
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007034 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7035
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007036
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007037option http-pretend-keepalive
7038no option http-pretend-keepalive
7039 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007041 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007042 Arguments : none
7043
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007044 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007045 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7046 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7047 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7048 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7049 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7050 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7051 consider the response complete.
7052
7053 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7054 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7055 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7056 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007057 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007058 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7059
7060 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7061 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7062 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7063 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7064 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7065 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7066 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7067
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007068 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7069 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7070 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7071 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7072 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7073 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007074
7075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7077
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007078 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007079 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007080
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007081
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007082option http-server-close
7083no option http-server-close
7084 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7086 yes | yes | yes | yes
7087 Arguments : none
7088
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007089 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7090 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7091 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7092 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007093 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7094 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7095 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7096 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7097 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7098 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7099 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7100 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7101 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7102 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7103 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007104
7105 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7106 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7107 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7108 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007109 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7110 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007111
7112 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7113 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007114 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7115 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7116 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007117
7118 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7119 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7120
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007121 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7122 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007123
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007124option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007125no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007126 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7128 yes | yes | yes | no
7129 Arguments : none
7130
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007131 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007132 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7133 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7134 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7135 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7136 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7137 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7138
7139 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7140 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007141 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7142 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7143 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007144
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007145 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7146 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7147 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7148 front of an existing proxy.
7149
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007150 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7151
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007152 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007153
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007154option httpchk
7155option httpchk <uri>
7156option httpchk <method> <uri>
7157option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
7158 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
7159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7160 yes | no | yes | yes
7161 Arguments :
7162 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7163 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7164 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7165 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7166 ones.
7167
7168 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7169 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7170 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7171
7172 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7173 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7174 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007175 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007176
7177 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7178 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7179 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7180 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7181 the lack of any response.
7182
7183 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
7184
7185 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
7186 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
7187 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
7188
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007189 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7190 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7191 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7192 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7193
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007194 Examples :
7195 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7196 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7197 backend https_relay
7198 mode tcp
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007199 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7200 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007201 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
7202
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007203 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7204 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7205 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007206
7207
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007208option httpclose
7209no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007210 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7212 yes | yes | yes | yes
7213 Arguments : none
7214
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007215 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7216 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7217 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7218 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007219 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007220
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007221 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7222 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007223 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007224 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7225 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007226
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007227 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7228 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7229 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007230
7231 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7232 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007233 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7234 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7235 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007236
7237 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7238 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7239
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007240 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007241
7242
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007243option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007244 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007246 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007247 Arguments :
7248 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7249 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7250 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007251 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007252 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007253
7254 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7255 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7256 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7257 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7258 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7259 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7260 ports.
7261
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007262 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7263 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007264
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007265 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007267 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007268
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007269
7270option http_proxy
7271no option http_proxy
7272 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7274 yes | yes | yes | yes
7275 Arguments : none
7276
7277 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7278 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7279 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7280 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7281 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7282
7283 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7284 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007285 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7286 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007287
7288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7290
7291 Example :
7292 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7293 backend direct_forward
7294 option httpclose
7295 option http_proxy
7296
7297 See also : "option httpclose"
7298
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007299
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007300option independent-streams
7301no option independent-streams
7302 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7304 yes | yes | yes | yes
7305 Arguments : none
7306
7307 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7308 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7309 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7310 receive data or not.
7311
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007312 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007313 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7314 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7315 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7316 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7317 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7318 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7319 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7320 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7321 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7322 socket buffers.
7323
7324 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7325 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7326 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7327 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7328 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7329
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007330 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007331
7332
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007333option ldap-check
7334 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 yes | no | yes | yes
7337 Arguments : none
7338
7339 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7340 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7341 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7342 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7343
7344 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7345 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7346
7347 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7348 configure it.
7349
7350 Example :
7351 option ldap-check
7352
7353 See also : "option httpchk"
7354
7355
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007356option external-check
7357 Use external processes for server health checks
7358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7359 yes | no | yes | yes
7360
7361 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7362 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7363 command".
7364
7365 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7366
7367 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7368
7369
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007370option log-health-checks
7371no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007372 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7374 yes | no | yes | yes
7375 Arguments : none
7376
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007377 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7378 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7379 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007380
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007381 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7382 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7383 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7384 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7385 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7386
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007387 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007388 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007389
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007390 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7391 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7392 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007393
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007394
7395option log-separate-errors
7396no option log-separate-errors
7397 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7399 yes | yes | yes | no
7400 Arguments : none
7401
7402 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7403 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7404 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7405 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7406 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7407 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7408 provides very important information.
7409
7410 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7411 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7412 error logs.
7413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007414 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007415 logging.
7416
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007417
7418option logasap
7419no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007420 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7422 yes | yes | yes | no
7423 Arguments : none
7424
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007425 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7426 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7427 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7428 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7429
7430 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7431 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7432 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7433 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7434 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7435 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7436 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7437 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7438 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7439 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7440 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007441
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007442 Examples :
7443 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7444 mode http
7445 option httplog
7446 option logasap
7447 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7448
7449 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7450 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7451 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7452 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007454 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007455 logging.
7456
7457
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007458option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007459 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7461 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007462 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007463 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7464 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007465 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007466
7467 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7468 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007469 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007470 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7471 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7472 in the MySQL table, like this :
7473
7474 USE mysql;
7475 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7476 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7477
7478 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007479 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007480 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7481 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7482 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7483 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7484 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7485 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7486 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7487
7488 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7489 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007490
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007491 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007492
7493 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7494 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7495 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7496 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007497 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7498 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007499
7500 See also: "option httpchk"
7501
7502
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007503option nolinger
7504no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007505 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7507 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007508 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007509
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007510 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007511 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7512 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7513 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7514 connections.
7515
7516 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7517 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7518 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7519 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7520 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7521 this too.
7522
7523 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7524 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7525 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7526
7527 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7528 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7529 for servers.
7530
7531 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7532 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7533
7534
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007535option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7536 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7538 yes | yes | yes | yes
7539 Arguments :
7540 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7541 matching <network>
7542 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7543 header name.
7544
7545 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7546 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7547 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7548 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7549 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7550 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7551 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7552 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7553 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7554 possible that the client has already brought one.
7555
7556 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7557 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7558 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7559 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7560 header and requires different one.
7561
7562 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7563 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7564 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7565 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7566 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7567 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7568 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7569
7570 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7571 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7572 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7573 both are defined.
7574
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007575 Examples :
7576 # Original Destination address
7577 frontend www
7578 mode http
7579 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7580
7581 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7582 backend www
7583 mode http
7584 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007586 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007587
7588
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007589option persist
7590no option persist
7591 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7593 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007594 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007595
7596 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7597 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7598 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7599 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7600 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7601 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7602 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7603 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7604 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7605 redirected to another valid server.
7606
7607 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7608 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7609
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007610 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007611
7612
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007613option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7614 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7616 yes | no | yes | yes
7617 Arguments :
7618 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7619 PostgreSQL server.
7620
7621 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7622 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7623 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7624 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7625
7626 See also: "option httpchk"
7627
7628
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007629option prefer-last-server
7630no option prefer-last-server
7631 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7632 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7633 yes | no | yes | yes
7634 Arguments : none
7635
7636 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7637 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7638 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7639 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7640 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7641 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7642 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7643 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7644 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007645 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7646 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007647 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7648 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7649 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007650 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7651 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7652 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007653
7654 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7655 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7656
7657 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7658
7659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007660option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007661option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007662no option redispatch
7663 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007666 Arguments :
7667 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7668 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7669 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007670 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007671 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007672 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007673 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7674 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7675 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007677
7678 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7679 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7680 be able to access the service anymore.
7681
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007682 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7683 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007684
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02007685 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
7686 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
7687 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
7688 following order:
7689
7690 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
7691
7692 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
7693 list, or
7694
7695 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
7696
7697 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
7698 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
7699
7700 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
7701 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
7702 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
7703 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
7704
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007705 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007706 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7707 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007709 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7710 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7711
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007712 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007713
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007714
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007715option redis-check
7716 Use redis health checks for server testing
7717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7718 yes | no | yes | yes
7719 Arguments : none
7720
7721 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7722 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7723 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7724 find the "+PONG" response message.
7725
7726 Example :
7727 option redis-check
7728
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007729 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007730
7731
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007732option smtpchk
7733option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7734 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7736 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007737 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007738 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007739 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007740 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7741
7742 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7743 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7744 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7745
7746 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7747 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7748 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7749 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7750 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7751 dead server.
7752
7753 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7754 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007755 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007756 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7757
7758 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7759 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7760 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7761 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007762 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007763
7764 Example :
7765 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7766
7767 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007770option socket-stats
7771no option socket-stats
7772
7773 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7775 yes | yes | yes | no
7776
7777 Arguments : none
7778
7779
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007780option splice-auto
7781no option splice-auto
7782 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7784 yes | yes | yes | yes
7785 Arguments : none
7786
7787 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7788 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007789 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007790 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007791 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007792 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7793 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7794 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7795 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7796
7797 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7798 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7799 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7800 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7801 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7802 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7803 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7804 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7805 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7806 keyword.
7807
7808 Example :
7809 option splice-auto
7810
7811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7813
7814 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7815 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7816
7817
7818option splice-request
7819no option splice-request
7820 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7822 yes | yes | yes | yes
7823 Arguments : none
7824
7825 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007826 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007827 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7828 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7829 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7830 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7831
7832 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7833
7834 Example :
7835 option splice-request
7836
7837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7839
7840 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7841 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7842
7843
7844option splice-response
7845no option splice-response
7846 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7848 yes | yes | yes | yes
7849 Arguments : none
7850
7851 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007852 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007853 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7854 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7855 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7856 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7857
7858 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7859
7860 Example :
7861 option splice-response
7862
7863 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7864 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7865
7866 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7867 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7868
7869
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007870option spop-check
7871 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7873 no | no | no | yes
7874 Arguments : none
7875
7876 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7877 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7878 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7879 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7880
7881 Example :
7882 option spop-check
7883
7884 See also : "option httpchk"
7885
7886
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007887option srvtcpka
7888no option srvtcpka
7889 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | no | yes | yes
7892 Arguments : none
7893
7894 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7895 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007896 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007897 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7898
7899 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7900 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7901 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7902 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7903
7904 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7905 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7906 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7907 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7908 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7909
7910 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7911
7912 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7913 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7914 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7915
7916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7918
7919 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7920
7921
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007922option ssl-hello-chk
7923 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7925 yes | no | yes | yes
7926 Arguments : none
7927
7928 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7929 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7930 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7931 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7932 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7933 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7934 hello message.
7935
7936 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7937 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7938 messages, which is appreciable.
7939
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007940 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7941 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7942 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007943
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007944 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7945
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007946
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007947option tcp-check
7948 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7950 yes | no | yes | yes
7951
7952 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7953 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7954
7955 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7956 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7957 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7958
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007959 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007960 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7961 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7962 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7963 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7964 only.
7965
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007966 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007967 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7968 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7969 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7970 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7971
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007972 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007973 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7974 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007975 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007976 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7977 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7978 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7979 the respective protocols.
7980 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007981 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007982
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007983 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7984 script.
7985
7986 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7987 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7988 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7989 The "comment" is of course optional.
7990
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01007991 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available
7992 to store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing
7993 those variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
7994
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007995
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007996 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007997 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007998 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007999 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008001 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008002 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008003 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008004
8005 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8006 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008007 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008008 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008009 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008010 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008011 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008012 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008013 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8014 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008015 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008016 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8017 tcp-check expect string +OK
8018
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008019 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008020 (send many headers before analyzing)
8021 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008022 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008023 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8024 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8025 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8026 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008027 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008028
8029
8030 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
8031
8032
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008033option tcp-smart-accept
8034no option tcp-smart-accept
8035 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8037 yes | yes | yes | no
8038 Arguments : none
8039
8040 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8041 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8042 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8043 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8044 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8045 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8046
8047 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8048 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8049 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8050 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8051
8052 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8053 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8054 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008055 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008056
8057 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8058 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8059 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8060
8061 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8062 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8063 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8064
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008065 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8066
8067
8068option tcp-smart-connect
8069no option tcp-smart-connect
8070 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8072 yes | no | yes | yes
8073 Arguments : none
8074
8075 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8076 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8077 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8078 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8079 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8080
8081 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8082 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8083 complex.
8084
8085 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8086 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8087 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8088
8089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8091
8092 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8093
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008094
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008095option tcpka
8096 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8098 yes | yes | yes | yes
8099 Arguments : none
8100
8101 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8102 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008103 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008104 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8105
8106 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8107 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8108 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8109 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8110
8111 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8112 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8113 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8114 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8115 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8116
8117 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8118
8119 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8120 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8121 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8122 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8123 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8124 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8125 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8126 backends.
8127
8128 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8129
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008130
8131option tcplog
8132 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008134 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008135 Arguments : none
8136
8137 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8138 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8139 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8140 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8141 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8142 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8143 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8144 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8145
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008146 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008148 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008149
8150
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008151option transparent
8152no option transparent
8153 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008155 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008156 Arguments : none
8157
8158 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8159 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8160 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8161 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8162 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8163 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8164 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8165 appropriate server.
8166
8167 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8168 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8169
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008170 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008171 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008172
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008173
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008174external-check command <command>
8175 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8177 yes | no | yes | yes
8178
8179 Arguments :
8180 <command> is the external command to run
8181
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008182 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8183
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008184 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008185
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008186 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8187 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8188 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8189 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8190 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8191 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008192
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008193 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8194
8195 Environment variables :
8196 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8197 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8198
8199 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8200
8201 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8202
8203 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8204 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8205 for a UNIX socket).
8206
8207 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8208
8209 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8210
8211 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8212
8213 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8214
8215 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8216
8217 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8218 socket).
8219
8220 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8221 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8222
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008223 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8224
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008225 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8226 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8227 failed.
8228
8229 Example :
8230 external-check command /bin/true
8231
8232 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8233
8234
8235external-check path <path>
8236 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8238 yes | no | yes | yes
8239
8240 Arguments :
8241 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8242
8243 The default path is "".
8244
8245 Example :
8246 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8247
8248 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8249 "external-check command"
8250
8251
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008252persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008253persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008254 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8256 yes | no | yes | yes
8257 Arguments :
8258 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008259 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8260 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008261
8262 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8263 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008264 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008265 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8266 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8267 forwarded to this server.
8268
8269 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8270 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8271 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008272 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008273 a single "listen" section.
8274
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008275 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8276 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8277 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8278
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008279 Example :
8280 listen tse-farm
8281 bind :3389
8282 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8283 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8284 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8285 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8286 persist rdp-cookie
8287 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008288 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008289 balance rdp-cookie
8290 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8291 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8292
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008293 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8294 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008295
8296
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008297rate-limit sessions <rate>
8298 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8300 yes | yes | yes | no
8301 Arguments :
8302 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8303 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8304
8305 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8306 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8307 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8308 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8309 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8310 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8311
8312 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8313 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8314 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8315 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8316
8317 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8318 listen smtp
8319 mode tcp
8320 bind :25
8321 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008322 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008323
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008324 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8325 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8326 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008327
8328 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8329
8330
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008331redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8332redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8333redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008334 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8336 no | yes | yes | yes
8337
8338 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008339 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008340
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008341 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008342 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008343 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8344 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8345 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008346
8347 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8348 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8349 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8350 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8351 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008352 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8353 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8354 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8355 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008356
8357 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8358 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8359 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8360 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8361 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8362 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008363 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008364 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008365 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8366 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8367 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008368
8369 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008370 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8371 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8372 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008373 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008374 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8375 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8376 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8377 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008378
8379 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008380 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008381
8382 - "drop-query"
8383 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8384 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8385 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8386 with a location-type redirect.
8387
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008388 - "append-slash"
8389 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8390 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8391 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8392 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8393
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008394 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8395 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8396 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8397 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8398 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8399 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8400 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8401
8402 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8403 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8404 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8405 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8406 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8407 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8408 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008409
8410 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8411 acl clear dst_port 80
8412 acl secure dst_port 8080
8413 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008414 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008415 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008416 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8417
8418 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008419 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8420 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8421 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008422 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008423
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008424 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8425 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8426 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8427
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008428 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008429 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008430
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008431 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008432 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8433 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8434 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008436 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008437
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008438
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008439retries <value>
8440 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8442 yes | no | yes | yes
8443 Arguments :
8444 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8445 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8446 default value is 3.
8447
8448 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8449 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8450 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8451
8452 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008453 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8454 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008455
8456 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8457 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8458
8459 See also : "option redispatch"
8460
8461
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008462retry-on [list of keywords]
8463 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 yes | no | yes | yes
8466 Arguments :
8467 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8468 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8469 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8470 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8471
8472 none never retry
8473
8474 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8475 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8476
8477 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8478 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8479 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8480 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8481 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8482 processing the request.
8483
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008484 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8485 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8486 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8487 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8488 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8489 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8490 overflow attack for example).
8491
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008492 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8493 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8494 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8495 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8496 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8497 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8498 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8499 amplify denial of service attacks.
8500
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008501 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8502 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8503 considered to be safe to retry.
8504
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008505 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8506 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8507 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8508 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8509
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008510 all-retryable-errors
8511 retry request for any error that are considered
8512 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8513 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8514 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8515
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008516 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8517 not cumulative.
8518
8519 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8520 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8521 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8522 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8523
8524 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8525 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8526 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8527 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8528 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8529 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8530 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8531 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8532 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8533 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8534 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8535 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8536
8537 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8538 should not use this directive.
8539
8540 The default is "conn-failure".
8541
8542 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8543
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008544server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008545 Declare a server in a backend
8546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8547 no | no | yes | yes
8548 Arguments :
8549 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008550 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008551 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008552
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008553 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8554 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8555 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8556 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008557 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8558 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8559 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8560 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8561 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008562 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8563 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8564 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8565 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8566 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8567 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8568 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008569 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008570 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8571 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8572 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8573 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8574 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8575 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008576 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8577 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008578 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8579 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008580
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008581 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008582 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8583 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8584 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8585 adding this value to the client's port.
8586
8587 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8588 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008589 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008590
8591 Examples :
8592 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8593 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008594 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008595 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8596 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8597 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008598
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008599 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8600 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8601 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8602 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8603 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8604
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008605 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8606 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008607
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008608server-state-file-name [<file>]
8609 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8610 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8611 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8612 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8613 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8614 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8615
8616 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8617 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8618
8619 global
8620 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8621
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008622 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008623 load-server-state-from-file
8624
8625 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8626 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008627
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008628server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8629 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8630 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8632 no | no | yes | yes
8633
8634 Arguments:
8635 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8636
8637 <num | range>
8638 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8639 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8640 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8641 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8642
8643 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8644
8645 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8646
8647 <params*>
8648 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8649 keyword.
8650
8651 Examples:
8652 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8653 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8654 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8655
8656 # or
8657 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8658
8659 # would be equivalent to:
8660 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8661 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8662 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8663
8664
8665
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008666source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008667source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008668source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008669 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8671 yes | no | yes | yes
8672 Arguments :
8673 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8674 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008675
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008676 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008677 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8678 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8679 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8680 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8681 supported prefixes are :
8682 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8683 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8684 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008685 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008686 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8687 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008688
8689 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8690 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008691 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8692 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8693 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008694
8695 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8696 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8697 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8698 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8699 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8700 <addr>.
8701
8702 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8703 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8704 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8705 port.
8706
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008707 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8708 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8709 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8710 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008711 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008712 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8713 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8714 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8715 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8716 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8717 HTTP header.
8718
8719 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8720 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008721 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008722 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8723 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8724 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8725 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8726 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8727 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8728 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8729
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008730 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8731 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8732 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8733 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8734 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8735 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8736
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008737 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8738 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8739 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8740 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8741
8742 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8743 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8744 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8745 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8746 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8747 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8748
8749 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8750 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8751 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8752 there are two methods :
8753
8754 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8755 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8756 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8757 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8758 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8759 of the client ranges may be used.
8760
8761 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8762 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8763 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8764 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8765 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8766 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8767 same session.
8768
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008769 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8770 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8771 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008772 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008773
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008774 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8775
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008776 Examples :
8777 backend private
8778 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8779 source 192.168.1.200
8780
8781 backend transparent_ssl1
8782 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8783 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8784
8785 backend transparent_ssl2
8786 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8787 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8788 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8789
8790 backend transparent_ssl3
8791 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8792 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8793 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8794
8795 backend transparent_smtp
8796 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8797 # with Tproxy version 4.
8798 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8799
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008800 backend transparent_http
8801 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8802 # proxy.
8803 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008805 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008806 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8807
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008808
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008809stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8810 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008812 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008813
8814 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8815 matched.
8816
8817 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8818 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8819
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008820 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8821 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008822 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008823
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008824 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8825 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8826 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8827 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008828
8829 Example :
8830 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8831 backend stats_localhost
8832 stats enable
8833 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8834
8835 Example :
8836 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8837 backend stats_auth
8838 stats enable
8839 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8840 stats admin if TRUE
8841
8842 Example :
8843 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8844 userlist stats-auth
8845 group admin users admin
8846 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8847 group readonly users haproxy
8848 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8849
8850 backend stats_auth
8851 stats enable
8852 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8853 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8854 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8855 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8856
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008857 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8858 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8859 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008860
8861
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008862stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8863 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008866 Arguments :
8867 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8868
8869 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8870
8871 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8872 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8873 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8874 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8875 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8876 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8877
8878 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8879 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8880 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008881 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008882
8883 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8884 report using "stats scope".
8885
8886 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8887 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8888 unobvious parameters.
8889
8890 Example :
8891 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8892 backend public_www
8893 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8894 stats enable
8895 stats hide-version
8896 stats scope .
8897 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008898 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008899 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8900 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8901
8902 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8903 backend private_monitoring
8904 stats enable
8905 stats uri /admin?stats
8906 stats refresh 5s
8907
8908 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8909
8910
8911stats enable
8912 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008914 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008915 Arguments : none
8916
8917 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8918 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8919 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8920 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8921 - stats auth : no authentication
8922 - stats scope : no restriction
8923
8924 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8925 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8926 unobvious parameters.
8927
8928 Example :
8929 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8930 backend public_www
8931 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8932 stats enable
8933 stats hide-version
8934 stats scope .
8935 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008936 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008937 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8938 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8939
8940 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8941 backend private_monitoring
8942 stats enable
8943 stats uri /admin?stats
8944 stats refresh 5s
8945
8946 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8947
8948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008949stats hide-version
8950 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008952 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008953 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008955 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8956 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8957 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8958 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8959 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8960 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008962 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8963 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8964 unobvious parameters.
8965
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008966 Example :
8967 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8968 backend public_www
8969 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008970 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008971 stats hide-version
8972 stats scope .
8973 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008974 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008975 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8976 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008977
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008978 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8979 backend private_monitoring
8980 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008981 stats uri /admin?stats
8982 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008983
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008984 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008985
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008986
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008987stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8988 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8989 Access control for statistics
8990
8991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8992 no | no | yes | yes
8993
8994 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8995 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8996 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8997 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8998 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8999 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9000
9001 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9002 instance.
9003
9004 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9005 about ACL usage.
9006
9007
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009008stats realm <realm>
9009 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009011 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009012 Arguments :
9013 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9014 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9015 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9016
9017 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9018 using a backslash ('\').
9019
9020 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9021 only related to authentication.
9022
9023 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9024 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9025 unobvious parameters.
9026
9027 Example :
9028 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9029 backend public_www
9030 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9031 stats enable
9032 stats hide-version
9033 stats scope .
9034 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009035 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009036 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9037 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9038
9039 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9040 backend private_monitoring
9041 stats enable
9042 stats uri /admin?stats
9043 stats refresh 5s
9044
9045 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9046
9047
9048stats refresh <delay>
9049 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009051 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009052 Arguments :
9053 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9054 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9055 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9056 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9057 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9058 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9059
9060 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9061 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9062 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9063 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9064
9065 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9066 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9067 unobvious parameters.
9068
9069 Example :
9070 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9071 backend public_www
9072 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9073 stats enable
9074 stats hide-version
9075 stats scope .
9076 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009077 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009078 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9079 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9080
9081 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9082 backend private_monitoring
9083 stats enable
9084 stats uri /admin?stats
9085 stats refresh 5s
9086
9087 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9088
9089
9090stats scope { <name> | "." }
9091 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009093 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009094 Arguments :
9095 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9096 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9097 section in which the statement appears.
9098
9099 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9100 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9101 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9102 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9103 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9104 exists.
9105
9106 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9107 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9108 unobvious parameters.
9109
9110 Example :
9111 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9112 backend public_www
9113 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9114 stats enable
9115 stats hide-version
9116 stats scope .
9117 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009118 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009119 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9120 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9121
9122 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9123 backend private_monitoring
9124 stats enable
9125 stats uri /admin?stats
9126 stats refresh 5s
9127
9128 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9129
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009130
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009131stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009132 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009134 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009135
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009136 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009137 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9138
9139 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9140 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9141
9142 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9143 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009144 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009145
9146 Example :
9147 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9148 backend private_monitoring
9149 stats enable
9150 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9151 stats uri /admin?stats
9152 stats refresh 5s
9153
9154 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9155 global section.
9156
9157
9158stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009159 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9161 yes | yes | yes | yes
9162 Arguments : none
9163
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009164 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009165 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9166 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9167 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9168 - IP (socket, server)
9169 - cookie (backend, server)
9170
9171 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9172 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009173 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009174
9175 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9176
9177
9178stats show-node [ <name> ]
9179 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009181 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009182 Arguments:
9183 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9184 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9185
9186 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9187 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009188 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009189
9190 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9191 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9192 unobvious parameters.
9193
9194 Example:
9195 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9196 backend private_monitoring
9197 stats enable
9198 stats show-node Europe-1
9199 stats uri /admin?stats
9200 stats refresh 5s
9201
9202 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9203 section.
9204
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009205
9206stats uri <prefix>
9207 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009209 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009210 Arguments :
9211 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9212 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9213 query string.
9214
9215 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9216 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9217 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9218 possible to reach it in the application.
9219
9220 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009221 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009222 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9223 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9224 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9225 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9226
9227 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9228 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9229 an address or a port to statistics only.
9230
9231 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9232 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9233 unobvious parameters.
9234
9235 Example :
9236 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9237 backend public_www
9238 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9239 stats enable
9240 stats hide-version
9241 stats scope .
9242 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009243 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009244 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9245 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9246
9247 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9248 backend private_monitoring
9249 stats enable
9250 stats uri /admin?stats
9251 stats refresh 5s
9252
9253 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9254
9255
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009256stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9257 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009259 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009260
9261 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009262 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009263 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009264 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009265 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9266
9267 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9268 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9269 the "stick-table" statement.
9270
9271 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9272 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9273 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9274 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9275 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9276
9277 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9278 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9279 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9280 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9281 transformation rules.
9282
9283 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9284 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9285 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9286 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9287 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9288 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9289 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9290
9291 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9292 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9293 ACL based conditions.
9294
9295 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9296 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9297 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9298 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9299
9300 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9301 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9302 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9303 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9304
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009305 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9306 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009307 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009308
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009309 Example :
9310 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9311 # last 30 minutes
9312 backend pop
9313 mode tcp
9314 balance roundrobin
9315 stick store-request src
9316 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9317 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9318 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9319
9320 backend smtp
9321 mode tcp
9322 balance roundrobin
9323 stick match src table pop
9324 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9325 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9326
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009327 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009328 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009329
9330
9331stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9332 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9334 no | no | yes | yes
9335
9336 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9337 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9338 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9339 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9340
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009341 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9342 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009343 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009344
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009345 Examples :
9346 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009347 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009348
9349 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9350 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9351 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9352
9353
9354 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9355 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9356 backend http
9357 mode http
9358 balance roundrobin
9359 stick on src table https
9360 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9361 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9362 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9363
9364 backend https
9365 mode tcp
9366 balance roundrobin
9367 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9368 stick on src
9369 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9370 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9371
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009372 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009373
9374
9375stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9376 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9378 no | no | yes | yes
9379
9380 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009381 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009382 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009383 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009384 server is selected.
9385
9386 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9387 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9388 the "stick-table" statement.
9389
9390 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9391 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9392 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9393 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9394 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9395 address.
9396
9397 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9398 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9399 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9400 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9401 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9402 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9403 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9404 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9405 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9406 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9407
9408 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9409 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9410 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9411 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9412 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9413 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9414 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9415
9416 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9417 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9418 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9419 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9420
9421 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9422 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9423 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9424 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9425 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9426 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009427 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9428 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9429 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9430 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9431 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9432 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009433
9434 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9435 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9436 the request.
9437
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009438 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9439 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009440 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009441
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009442 Example :
9443 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9444 # last 30 minutes
9445 backend pop
9446 mode tcp
9447 balance roundrobin
9448 stick store-request src
9449 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9450 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9451 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9452
9453 backend smtp
9454 mode tcp
9455 balance roundrobin
9456 stick match src table pop
9457 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9458 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9459
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009460 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009461 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009462
9463
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009464stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009465 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9466 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009467 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009469 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009470
9471 Arguments :
9472 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9473 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9474 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9475 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9476
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009477 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9478 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9479 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9480 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9481
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009482 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9483 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9484 instance.
9485
9486 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9487 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9488 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9489 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9490 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9491 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009492 to 32 characters.
9493
9494 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9495 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9496 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009497 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009498 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9499 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009500
9501 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009502 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9503 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009504 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9505 increase.
9506
9507 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009508 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9509 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9510 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009511
9512 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9513 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9514 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9515 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009516 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009517 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9518 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9519 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9520 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9521 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9522 parameter (see below).
9523
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009524 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9525 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9526 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9527 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9528 soft restart.
9529
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009530 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9531 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009532
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009533 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9534 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9535 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9536 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009537 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009538 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009539 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9540 if not expiration delay is specified.
9541
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009542 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9543 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9544 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9545 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009546 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9547 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9548 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9549 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9550 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9551 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9552 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9553 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9554 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9555 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9556 types and their arguments.
9557
9558 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9559 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9560 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9561 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9562
9563 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9564 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9565 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009566 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009567
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009568 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9569 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9570 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009571 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009572 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009573 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009574
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009575 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9576 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9577 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9578 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9579
9580 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9581 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9582 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9583 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9584 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9585 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9586
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009587 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9588 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9589 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9590 they were received.
9591
9592 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9593 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9594 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9595 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9596 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9597
9598 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9599 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9600 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9601 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9602 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9603
9604 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9605 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9606 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9607
9608 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9609 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9610 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9611 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9612 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9613
9614 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9615 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9616 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9617 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9618 the client side.
9619
9620 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9621 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9622 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9623 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9624 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9625 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9626 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9627
9628 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9629 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9630 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9631 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9632 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9633 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009634 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009635
9636 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9637 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9638 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9639 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9640 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9641 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9642
9643 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009644 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009645 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9646 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9647
9648 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9649 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9650 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9651 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9652 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9653 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9654 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9655 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9656 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9657 recommended for better fairness.
9658
9659 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009660 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009661 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9662 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9663
9664 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9665 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9666 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9667 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9668 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9669 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9670 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9671 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9672 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9673 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009674
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009675 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9676 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009677 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9678 reference it.
9679
9680 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9681 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009682 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9683 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9684 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009685
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009686 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9687 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9688 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9689 something that can be ignored.
9690
9691 Example:
9692 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9693 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9694 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9695 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9696
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009697 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009698 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009699
9700
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009701stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009702 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9704 no | no | yes | yes
9705
9706 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009707 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009708 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009709 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009710 server is selected.
9711
9712 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9713 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9714 the "stick-table" statement.
9715
9716 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9717 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9718 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9719 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9720
9721 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9722 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9723 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9724 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9725 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9726 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009727 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009728 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9729 rules.
9730
9731 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9732 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9733 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9734 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9735 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9736 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9737 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9738
9739 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9740 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9741 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9742 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9743
9744 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9745 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9746 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9747 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9748 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9749 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009750 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9751 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9752 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9753 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9754 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9755 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9756 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9757 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9758 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009759
9760 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9761
9762 Example :
9763 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9764 backend https
9765 mode tcp
9766 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009767 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009768 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009769
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009770 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9771 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9772
9773 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9774 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9775 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9776
9777 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9778 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009779
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009780 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9781 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9782 # at offset 44.
9783
9784 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9785 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9786
9787 # Learn on response if server hello.
9788 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009789
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009790 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9791 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9792
9793 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9794 extraction.
9795
9796
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009797tcp-check connect [params*]
9798 Opens a new connection
9799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9800 no | no | yes | yes
9801
9802 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9803 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9804 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9805
9806 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9807 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9808 of the sequence.
9809
9810 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9811 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9812 do.
9813
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009814 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
9815 unset-var or comment rules.
9816
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009817 Parameters :
9818 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9819 use the TCP connection.
9820
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +02009821 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
9822 checks. This parameter is exclusive with all other options.
9823
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +02009824 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009825 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9826 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +02009827 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009828
9829 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009830
9831 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9832
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +02009833 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
9834
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009835 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9836
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +02009837 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
9838
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +02009839 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
9840 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
9841 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
9842 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
9843
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +02009844 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009845
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009846 Examples:
9847 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9848 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9849 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9850 option tcp-check
9851 tcp-check connect
9852 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9853 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9854 tcp-check send \r\n
9855 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9856 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9857 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9858 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9859 tcp-check send \r\n
9860 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9861 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9862
9863 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9864 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009865 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009866 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9867 tcp-check connect port 143
9868 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9869 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9870
9871 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9872
9873
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009874tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009875 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9877 no | no | yes | yes
9878
9879 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009880 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
9881 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
9882 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
9883 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
9884 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
9885 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
9886 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
9887 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
9888 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
9889 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
9890
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009891 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009892 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
9893 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009894 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9895 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9896 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9897
9898 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9899 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9900 with the usual backslash ('\').
9901 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009902 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009903 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9904 used upper or lower case.
9905
9906
9907 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9908
9909 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9910 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9911 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9912 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9913 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9914 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9915 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9916 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9917
9918 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9919 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9920 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9921 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9922 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9923 expression.
9924
9925 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9926 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9927 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9928 this exact hexadecimal string.
9929 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9930
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +01009931 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
9932 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
9933 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
9934 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
9935 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
9936 size of the original response. As such, the expected
9937 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
9938 size.
9939
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009940 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9941 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9942 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9943 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9944 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9945 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9946 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9947 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9948 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9949 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9950 the null character.
9951
9952 Examples :
9953 # perform a POP check
9954 option tcp-check
9955 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9956
9957 # perform an IMAP check
9958 option tcp-check
9959 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9960
9961 # look for the redis master server
9962 option tcp-check
9963 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009964 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009965 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9966 tcp-check expect string role:master
9967 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9968 tcp-check expect string +OK
9969
9970
9971 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9972 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9973
9974
9975tcp-check send <data>
9976 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9978 no | no | yes | yes
9979
9980 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9981 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9982
9983 Examples :
9984 # look for the redis master server
9985 option tcp-check
9986 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9987 tcp-check expect string role:master
9988
9989 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9990 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9991
9992
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009993tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9994 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009995 tcp health check
9996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9997 no | no | yes | yes
9998
9999 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10000 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010001 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010002 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10003 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10004 hexadecimal string.
10005 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10006
10007 Examples :
10008 # redis check in binary
10009 option tcp-check
10010 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10011 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10012
10013
10014 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10015 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10016
10017
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010018tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10019
10020 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
10021
10022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10023 no | no | yes | yes
10024
10025 Arguments:
10026 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10027 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10028 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10029 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10030 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10031 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10032 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10033 and '-'.
10034
10035 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10036
10037 Example:
10038 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10039
10040
10041tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
10042
10043 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
10044
10045 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10046 no | no | yes | yes
10047
10048 Arguments:
10049 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10050 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10051 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10052 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10053 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10054 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10055 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10056 and '-'.
10057
10058 Example:
10059 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10060
10061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010062tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10063 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10065 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010066 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010067 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10068 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010070 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010071
10072 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10073 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010074 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10075 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10076 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10077 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10078 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10079 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010080
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010081 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10082 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10083 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10084 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010085
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010086 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010087 - accept :
10088 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10089 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10090 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010092 - reject :
10093 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10094 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10095 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10096 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10097 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10098 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10099 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10100 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10101 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10102 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10103 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010104 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010105
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010106 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10107 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10108 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10109 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10110 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10111 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10112 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10113 hosts.
10114
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010115 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10116 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10117 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10118 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10119 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10120 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10121 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10122 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10123
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010124 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10125 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10126 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10127 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10128 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10129 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10130 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10131 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10132 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010133 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10134 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010135
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010136 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010137 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010138 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10139 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10140 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010141 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010142 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10143 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10144 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10145 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10146 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10147 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10148 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10149 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010151 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010152 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010153 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010154 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010155 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10156 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10157 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010159 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10160 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10161 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10162 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010164 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10165 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10166 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10167 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10168 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010169 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10170 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10171 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10172 layer7 information is extracted.
10173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010174 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10175 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10176 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10177 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10178 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010179
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010180 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10181 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10182 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10183 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10184
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010185 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10186 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10187 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10188 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10189
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010190 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10191 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10192 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10193 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10194 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010195
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010196 - set-src <expr> :
10197 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10198 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10199 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010200 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010202 Arguments:
10203 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10204 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010205
10206 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010207 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10208
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010209 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10210 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010211
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010212 - set-src-port <expr> :
10213 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10214 expression.
10215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010216 Arguments:
10217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10218 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010219
10220 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010221 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10222
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010223 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10224 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10225 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010226
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010227 - set-dst <expr> :
10228 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10229 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10230 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10231 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10232 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10233
10234 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10235 followed by some converters.
10236
10237 Example:
10238
10239 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10240 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10241
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010242 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10243 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10244
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010245 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10246 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10247 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10248 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10249
10250
10251 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10252 followed by some converters.
10253
10254 Example:
10255
10256 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10257
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010258 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10259 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10260 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10261
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010262 - "silent-drop" :
10263 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010264 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010265 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10266 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10267 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10268 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10269 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010270 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10271 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010272 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10273 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010274 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010275 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10276 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10277 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10278 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10279
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010280 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10281 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10282 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010283
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010284 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10285 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10286 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010288 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010289 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010290 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010291
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010292 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10293 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10294 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010296 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010297 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10298 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010299
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010300 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10301
10302 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10303
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010304 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10305
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010306 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010307
10308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010309tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10310 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010312 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010313 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010314 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10315 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010317 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010318
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010319 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010320 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10321 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10322 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10323 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010325 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10326 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10327 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10328 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010329 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10330 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10331 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10332 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10333 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10334 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010335 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010336 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010337
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010338 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10339 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10340 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10341 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010342
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010343 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010344 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010345 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010346 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10347 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010348 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010349 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010350 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010351 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010352 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010353 - set-dst <expr>
10354 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010355 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010356 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010357 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010358 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010359 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010360
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010361 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10362 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010363 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10364 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010365
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010366 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10367 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10368 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10369 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10370 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10371 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010373 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010374 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10375 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010377 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010378 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10379 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10380 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10381 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010382 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10383 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10384 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010385
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010386 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010387 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10388 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10389 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010390
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010391 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10392 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10393
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010394 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010395 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10396 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010397
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010398 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10399 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010400 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010401 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10402 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010403 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010404 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010405 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010406 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10407 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010408 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010409 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10410 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010411
10412 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10413 followed by some converters.
10414
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010415 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10416 <var-name>.
10417
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010418 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10419 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10420 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10421 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10422 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10423
10424 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10425 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10426 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10427 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10428 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10429 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10430 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10431 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10432 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10433 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10434 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10435
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010436 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10437 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10438 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10439 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10440 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10441
10442 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10443
10444 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10445
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010446 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10447 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10448 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10449 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10450 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10451 evaluated.
10452
10453 Example:
10454 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10455
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010456 Example:
10457
10458 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010459 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010460
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010461 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010462 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10463 # and reject everything else.
10464 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10465 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010466 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010467 tcp-request content reject
10468
10469 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010470 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10471 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10472 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010473 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010474
10475 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10476 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10477 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010478 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010479 tcp-request content reject
10480
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010481 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010482 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010483 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010484 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010485 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10486 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010487
10488 Example:
10489 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10490 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010491 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010492
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010493 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010494 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010495
10496 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010497 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010498 # protecting all our sites
10499 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010500 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10501 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010502 ...
10503 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10504
10505 backend http_dynamic
10506 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010507 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010508 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010509 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010510 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010511 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010512 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010514 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010515
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010516 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10517 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010518
10519
10520tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10521 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010523 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010524 Arguments :
10525 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10526 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10527 as explained at the top of this document.
10528
10529 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10530 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10531 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10532 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10533 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10534
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010535 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10536 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10537 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10538 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10539
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010540 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10541 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010542 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010543 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010544 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10545 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10546 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10547 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010548
10549 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10550 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10551 it pass through unaffected.
10552
10553 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10554 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10555 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010556 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010557 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10558 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010559 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10560 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10561 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010562
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010563 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010564 "timeout client".
10565
10566
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010567tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10568 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10570 no | no | yes | yes
10571 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010572 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10573 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010574
10575 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10576
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010577 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010578 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10579 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010580 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10581 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010582
10583 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10584
10585 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10586 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10587 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10588 inserted.
10589
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010590 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010591 - accept :
10592 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10593 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10594 the rules evaluation.
10595
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010596 - close :
10597 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10598 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10599 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10600 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10601 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10602 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010603 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010604 protocols.
10605
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010606 - reject :
10607 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10608 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010609 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010610
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010611 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10612 Sets a variable.
10613
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010614 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10615 Unsets a variable.
10616
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010617 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10618 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10619 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10620 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10621
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010622 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10623 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10624 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10625 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10626
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010627 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10628 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10629 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10630 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10631 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010632
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010633 - "silent-drop" :
10634 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010635 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010636 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10637 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10638 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10639 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10640 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010641 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10642 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010643 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10644 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010645 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010646 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10647 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10648 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10649 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10650
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010651 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10652 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10653
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010654 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10655 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10656 for changing the default action to a reject.
10657
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010658 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10659 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10660 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10661 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010662 period.
10663
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010664 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10665 declared inline.
10666
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010667 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10668 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010669 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010670 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10671 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010672 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010673 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010674 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10676 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010677 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010678 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10679 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010680
10681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10682 followed by some converters.
10683
10684 Example:
10685
10686 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10687
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010688 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10689 <var-name>.
10690
10691 Example:
10692
10693 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10694
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010695 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10696 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10697 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10698 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10699 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10700
10701 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10702
10703 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10704
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010705 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10706
10707 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10708
10709
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010710tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10711 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10713 no | yes | yes | no
10714 Arguments :
10715 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10716 below.
10717
10718 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010720 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010721 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10722 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10723 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10724 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10725 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10726 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10727 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010728 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010729 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10730 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10731 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10732 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10733 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10734 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10735 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10736 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10737 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10738 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10739 instead.
10740
10741 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10742 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10743 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10744 rules which may be inserted.
10745
10746 Several types of actions are supported :
10747 - accept : the request is accepted
10748 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10749 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10750 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010751 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010752 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010753 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010754 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010755 - silent-drop
10756
10757 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10758 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10759 sections for a complete description.
10760
10761 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10762 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10763 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10764
10765 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10766 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10767 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10768 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10769 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10770
10771 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10772 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10773
10774 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10775 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10776 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10777
10778 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10779 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10780 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10781
10782 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10783 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10784 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10785
10786 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10787 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10788 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10789
10790 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10791
10792 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10793
10794
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010795tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10796 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10798 no | no | yes | yes
10799 Arguments :
10800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10802 as explained at the top of this document.
10803
10804 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10805
10806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010807timeout check <timeout>
10808 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10809 established.
10810
10811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10812 yes | no | yes | yes
10813 Arguments:
10814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10816 as explained at the top of this document.
10817
10818 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10819 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010820 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010821 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010822 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10823 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10824 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010825
10826 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10827 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10828
10829 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10830 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010831 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010832
10833 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10834 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10835 forget about it.
10836
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010837 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10838 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010839
10840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010841timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010842 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10844 yes | yes | yes | no
10845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10848 as explained at the top of this document.
10849
10850 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10851 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10852 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010853 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10854 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10855 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10856 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010857 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10858 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10859 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010860 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010861 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010862 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10863 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010864 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10865 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010866
10867 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10868 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10869 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10870 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010871 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010872 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10873
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010874 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010875
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010876 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010878
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010879timeout client-fin <timeout>
10880 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10882 yes | yes | yes | no
10883 Arguments :
10884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10886 as explained at the top of this document.
10887
10888 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10889 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10890 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10891 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10892 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10893 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10894 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010895 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10896 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10897 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010898
10899 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10900 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10901 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10902
10903 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10904
10905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010906timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010907 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10909 yes | no | yes | yes
10910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10913 as explained at the top of this document.
10914
10915 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010916 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010917 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010918 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010919 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10920 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010921
10922 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10923 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10924 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10925 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010926 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010927 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10928
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010929 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010931
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010932timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10933 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10935 yes | yes | yes | yes
10936 Arguments :
10937 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10938 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10939 as explained at the top of this document.
10940
10941 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10942 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10943 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10944 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10945 once the request has started to present itself.
10946
10947 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10948 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10949 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10950 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10951 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10952
10953 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10954 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10955 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10956 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10957
10958 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10959 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010961 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10962 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010963 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010964
10965 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10966 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10967 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10968 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10969
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010970 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10971 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010972 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10973
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010974 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10975
10976
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010977timeout http-request <timeout>
10978 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010982 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010983 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10984 as explained at the top of this document.
10985
10986 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10987 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10988 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10989 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10990 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10991 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10992 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010993 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10994 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10995 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10996 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010997 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010998 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10999 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011000
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011001 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11002 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11003 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11004 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11005 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011006 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011007
11008 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11009 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011011 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11012 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11013
11014 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011015 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11016 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11017 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011018
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011019 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011020 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011021
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011022
11023timeout queue <timeout>
11024 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11026 yes | no | yes | yes
11027 Arguments :
11028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11030 as explained at the top of this document.
11031
11032 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11033 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11034 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11035 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11036 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11037
11038 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11039 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11040 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11041 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11042
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011043 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011044
11045
11046timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011047 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11049 yes | no | yes | yes
11050 Arguments :
11051 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11053 as explained at the top of this document.
11054
11055 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11056 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11057 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11058 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11059 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11060 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11061 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11062
11063 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11064 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11065 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11066 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11067 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011068 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011069 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011070 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11071 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011072 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11073 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011074
11075 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11076 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11077 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11078 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011079 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011080 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11081
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011082 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011083
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011084
11085timeout server-fin <timeout>
11086 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11088 yes | no | yes | yes
11089 Arguments :
11090 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11091 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11092 as explained at the top of this document.
11093
11094 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11095 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11096 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11097 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11098 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11099 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11100 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11101 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11102 situations, it should not be needed.
11103
11104 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11105 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11106 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11107
11108 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11109
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011110
11111timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011112 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11114 yes | yes | yes | yes
11115 Arguments :
11116 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11117 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11118 as explained at the top of this document.
11119
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011120 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11121 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11122 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011123
11124 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11125 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11126 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11127 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011128 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011129
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011130 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011131
11132
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011133timeout tunnel <timeout>
11134 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11136 yes | no | yes | yes
11137 Arguments :
11138 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11139 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11140 as explained at the top of this document.
11141
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011142 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011143 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11144 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11145 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011146 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11147 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011148 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11149 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11150 specified.
11151
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011152 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11153 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11154 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11155 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11156 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11157 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11158 state.
11159
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011160 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11161 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11162 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11163 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011164 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011165
11166 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11167 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11168 forget about it.
11169
11170 Example :
11171 defaults http
11172 option http-server-close
11173 timeout connect 5s
11174 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011175 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011176 timeout server 30s
11177 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11178
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011179 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011180
11181
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011182transparent (deprecated)
11183 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011185 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011186 Arguments : none
11187
11188 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11189 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11190 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11191 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11192 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11193 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11194 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11195 appropriate server.
11196
11197 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11198
11199 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11200 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11201
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011202 See also: "option transparent"
11203
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011204unique-id-format <string>
11205 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11207 yes | yes | yes | no
11208 Arguments :
11209 <string> is a log-format string.
11210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011211 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11212 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11213 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11214 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011215
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011216 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11217 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11218 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11219 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11220 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11221 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11222 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11223 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011224
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011225 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11226 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011227
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011228 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011229
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011230 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011231
11232 will generate:
11233
11234 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11235
11236 See also: "unique-id-header"
11237
11238unique-id-header <name>
11239 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11241 yes | yes | yes | no
11242 Arguments :
11243 <name> is the name of the header.
11244
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011245 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11246 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011247
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011248 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011249
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011250 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011251 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11252
11253 will generate:
11254
11255 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11256
11257 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011258
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011259use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011260 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11262 no | yes | yes | no
11263 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011264 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11265 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011266
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011267 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11268 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011269
11270 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11271 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11272 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011273 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011274 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011275 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11276 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011277
11278 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11279 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11280 assign the backend.
11281
11282 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11283 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11284 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11285 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11286 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11287 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11288
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011289 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011290 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011291 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11292 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11293 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11294
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011295 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11296 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11297 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11298 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11299 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11300 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11301 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11302 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11303 cannot be forced from the request.
11304
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011305 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011306 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11307 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11308
11309 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11310 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011311
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011312use-fcgi-app <name>
11313 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11315 no | no | yes | yes
11316 Arguments :
11317 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11318
11319 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011320
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011321use-server <server> if <condition>
11322use-server <server> unless <condition>
11323 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11325 no | no | yes | yes
11326 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011327 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11328 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011329
11330 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11331
11332 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11333 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11334 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11335
11336 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11337 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11338 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11339 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11340 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11341 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11342 matches will assign the server.
11343
11344 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11345 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11346 with the next rules until one matches.
11347
11348 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11349 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11350 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11351 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11352
11353 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11354 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11355 stripped.
11356
11357 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11358 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11359 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11360 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11361
11362 Example :
11363 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11364 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11365 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11366 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11367 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11368 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011369 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011370 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11371 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11372
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011373 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11374 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11375 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11376 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11377 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11378 and we fall back to load balancing.
11379
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011380 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011381
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113835. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011384--------------------------
11385
11386The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11387depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11388settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11389written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11390described in this section.
11391
11392
113935.1. Bind options
11394-----------------
11395
11396The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11397as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11398no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11399parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11400while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11401provided immediately after the setting name.
11402
11403The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11404
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011405accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11406 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11407 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11408 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11409 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11410 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11411 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11412 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11413 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11414 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011415 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11416 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11417 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011418
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011419accept-proxy
11420 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011421 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11422 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011423 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11424 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11425 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11426 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011427 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011428 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11429 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011430 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11431 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011432
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011433allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011434 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011435 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011436 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011437 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11438 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011439
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011440alpn <protocols>
11441 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11442 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11443 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011444 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011445 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011446 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11447 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11448 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11449 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11450 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11451 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11452 preference, like below :
11453
11454 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011455
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011456backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011457 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011458 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11459
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011460curves <curves>
11461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11462 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11463 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11464 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11465 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11466 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11467
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011468ecdhe <named curve>
11469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011470 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11471 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011472
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011473ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11475 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11476 client's certificate.
11477
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011478ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11480 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11481 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11482 error is ignored.
11483
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011484ca-sign-file <cafile>
11485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11486 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11487 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11488 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11489 'generate-certificates' for details.
11490
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011491ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11493 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11494 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11495 'generate-certificates' for details.
11496
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011497ca-verify-file <cafile>
11498 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
11499 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
11500 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
11501 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
11502 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
11503
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011504ciphers <ciphers>
11505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11506 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011507 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011508 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011509 information and recommendations see e.g.
11510 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11511 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11512 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11513
11514ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11516 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11517 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11518 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011519 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11520 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011521
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011522crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11524 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11525 to verify client's certificate.
11526
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011527crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11529 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11530 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11531 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11532 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010011533 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
11534 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011535
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010011536 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
11537 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
11538
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011539 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11540 are loaded.
11541
11542 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010011543 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
11544 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
11545 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
11546 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
11547 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
11548 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
11549 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011550 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011551
11552 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11553 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11554 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11555 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011556 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11557 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011558
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011559 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011560
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011561 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011562 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011563 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11564 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011565 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11566 clients).
11567
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011568 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11569 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11570 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11571 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11572 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11573 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11574 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11575 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11576 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11577 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11578 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11579 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11580 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11581
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011582 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11583 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11584 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11585 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11586 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11587
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011588 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11589 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11590 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11591 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011592
11593 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11594 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11595 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11596 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11597 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11598 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11599 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11600 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11601 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11602
11603 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11604
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011605 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011606 a cert bundle.
11607
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011608 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011609 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11610 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11611 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11612 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11613 provide multi-cert support.
11614
11615 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11616
11617 Filename | CN | SAN
11618 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11619 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011620 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011621 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11622 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11623
11624 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11625 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11626 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11627 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011628 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11629 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11630 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011631
11632 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11633 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11634
11635 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11636 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11637 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11638
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011639crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011640 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011641 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011642 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011643 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011644
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011645crt-list <file>
11646 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011647 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11648 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011649
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011650 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11651
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011652 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
11653 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
11654 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
11655 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011656
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011657 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11658 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11659 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11660 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11661 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11662 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11663 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11664 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011665
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011666 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011667 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011668 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11669 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11670 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011671
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011672 crt-list file example:
11673 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011674 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011675 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011676 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011678defer-accept
11679 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11680 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11681 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011682 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011683 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11684 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11685 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11686 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11687 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11688 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11689 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11690
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011691expose-fd listeners
11692 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11693 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011694 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11695 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011696 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011697
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011698force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011699 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011700 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011701 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011702 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011703
11704force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011705 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011706 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011707 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011708
11709force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011710 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011711 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011712 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011713
11714force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011715 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011716 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011717 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011718
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011719force-tlsv13
11720 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11721 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011722 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011723
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011724generate-certificates
11725 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11726 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11727 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11728 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11729 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11730 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11731 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11732 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11733 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11734 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11735 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11736
11737 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11738 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011739 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011740 certificate is used many times.
11741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011742gid <gid>
11743 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11744 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11745 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11746 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11747 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11748
11749group <group>
11750 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11751 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11752 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11753 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11754 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11755
11756id <id>
11757 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11758 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11759 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11760 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11761
11762interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011763 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11764 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11765 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11766 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11767 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11768 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011769 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11770 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11771 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11772 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11773 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11774 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011775
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011776level <level>
11777 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11778 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11779 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011780 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011781 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11782 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11783 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011784 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011785 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011786 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011787 all counters).
11788
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011789severity-output <format>
11790 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11791 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11792 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11793 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11794 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11795 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11796 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11797 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11798 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11799 rfc5424 convention.
11800
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011801maxconn <maxconn>
11802 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11803 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11804 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11805 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11806 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11807 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11808 eat all memory.
11809
11810mode <mode>
11811 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11812 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11813 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11814 UNIX sockets.
11815
11816mss <maxseg>
11817 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11818 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11819 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11820 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11821 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11822 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11823 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11824 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11825 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11826 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11827 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11828
11829name <name>
11830 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11831 page.
11832
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011833namespace <name>
11834 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11835 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11836 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11837 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11838
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011839nice <nice>
11840 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11841 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11842 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11843 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11844 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11845 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11846 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11847 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11848 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11849 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11850 one for an RDP socket.
11851
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011852no-ca-names
11853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11854 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010011855 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011856
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011857no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011859 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011860 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011861 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011862 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11863 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011864
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011865no-tls-tickets
11866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11867 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11868 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011869 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11870 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011871 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11872 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11873 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011874
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011875no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011877 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011878 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011879 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011880 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11881 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011882
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011883no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011884 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011885 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011886 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011887 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011888 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11889 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011890
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011891no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011893 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011894 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011895 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011896 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11897 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011898
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011899no-tlsv13
11900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11901 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11902 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11903 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011904 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11905 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011906
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011907npn <protocols>
11908 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11909 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11910 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011911 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011912 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011913 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11914 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11915 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11916 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11917 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011918
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011919prefer-client-ciphers
11920 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11921 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11922 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011923 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11924 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11925 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011926
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011927process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011928 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011929 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011930 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011931 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11932 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11933 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11934 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011935 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011936 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11937 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11938 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11939 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11940 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011941
11942 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11943
11944 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11945 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11946 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11947 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11948 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11949 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11950 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11951 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011952
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011953proto <name>
11954 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11955 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11956 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11957 in haproxy -vv.
11958 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11959 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011960 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011961 h2" on the bind line.
11962
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011963ssl
11964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011965 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011966 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11967 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011968 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11969 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011970
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011971ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11972 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11973 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11974 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11975
11976ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11977 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11978 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11979 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11980
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011981strict-sni
11982 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11983 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11984 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11985 See the "crt" option for more information.
11986
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011987tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011988 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011989 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11990 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011991 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011992 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11993 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11994 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11995 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11996 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11997 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11998 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11999
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012000tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012001 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012002 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12003 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12004 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12005 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12006 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12007 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12008 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012009 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12010 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12011 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012012
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012013tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12014 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012015 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12016 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12017 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12018 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12019 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12020 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12021 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12022 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12023 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12024 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012025 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12026 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12027
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012028transparent
12029 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12030 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12031 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12032 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12033 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12034 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12035 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12036 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12037 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12038 so check for support with your vendor.
12039
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012040v4v6
12041 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12042 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12043 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12044 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012045 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012046
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012047v6only
12048 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12049 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12050 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012051 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12052 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012053
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012054uid <uid>
12055 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12056 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12057 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12058 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12059 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12060
12061user <user>
12062 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12063 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12064 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12065 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12066 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12067
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012068verify [none|optional|required]
12069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12070 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12071 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12072 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12073 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012074 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12075 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12076 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12077 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012078
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120795.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012080------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012081
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012082The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12083which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12084arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12085settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12086after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12087Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12088address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012090 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012091 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012092
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012093Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12094keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12095
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012096The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012097
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012098addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012099 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012100 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12101 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12102 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12103 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12104 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012105
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012106agent-check
12107 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012108 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012109 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12110 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12111 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012112
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012113 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012114 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012115 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12116 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12117 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012119 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12120 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12121 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12122 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12123 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012124
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012125 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012126 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012127
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012128 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12129 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12130 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012131
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012132 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12133 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12134 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012135
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012136 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12137 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12138 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12139 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12140 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012141 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012142 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012143
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012144 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12145 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012146
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012147 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12148 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12149 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12150 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12151 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12152 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12153 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12154 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12155 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012156
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012157 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12158 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012159 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12160 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12161 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012162 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012163
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012164 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012165 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012166
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012167agent-send <string>
12168 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12169 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12170 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12171 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12172 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12173
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012174agent-inter <delay>
12175 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12176 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12177
12178 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12179 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12180 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12181 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12182 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12183 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12184 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12185 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12186 of backends use the same servers.
12187
12188 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12189
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012190agent-addr <addr>
12191 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12192
12193 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12194 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12195 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12196 hostname, it will be resolved.
12197
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012198agent-port <port>
12199 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12200
12201 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12202
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012203allow-0rtt
12204 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012205 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12206 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012207
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012208alpn <protocols>
12209 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12210 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12211 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012212 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012213 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12214 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12215 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12216 now obsolete NPN extension.
12217 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12218 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12219
12220 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012222backup
12223 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12224 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12225 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12226 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012227 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12228 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012229
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012230ca-file <cafile>
12231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12232 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12233 server's certificate.
12234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012235check
12236 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012237 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12238 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12239 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12240 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12241 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12242 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12243 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012244 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12245 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012246 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12247 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012248
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012249check-send-proxy
12250 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12251 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12252 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12253 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12254 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12255 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12256 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12257
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012258check-alpn <protocols>
12259 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12260 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12261 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12262
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012263check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012264 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012265 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12266 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012267
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012268check-ssl
12269 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12270 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12271 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12272 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012273 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012274 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12275 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012276 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012277 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12278 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012279
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012280check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012281 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012282 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12283 for normal traffic.
12284
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012285ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12287 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12288 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012289 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12290 information and recommendations see e.g.
12291 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12292 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12293 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012294
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012295ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12297 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12298 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12299 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012300 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12301 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12302 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012304cookie <value>
12305 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12306 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12307 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12308 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12309 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12310 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12311 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12312
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012313crl-file <crlfile>
12314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12315 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12316 to verify server's certificate.
12317
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012318crt <cert>
12319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12320 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12321 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12322 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12323 certificate request.
12324
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012325disabled
12326 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12327 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12328 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12329 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12330 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012331 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012332
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012333enabled
12334 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12335 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12336 default value.
12337 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12338 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012340error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012341 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12342 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12343 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012345 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012347fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012348 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12349 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12350 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12351
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012352force-sslv3
12353 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12354 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012355 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012356 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012357
12358force-tlsv10
12359 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012360 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012361 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012362
12363force-tlsv11
12364 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012365 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012366 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012367
12368force-tlsv12
12369 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012370 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012371 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012372
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012373force-tlsv13
12374 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12375 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012376 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012378id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012379 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12380 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12381 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012382
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012383init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12384 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12385 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012386 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012387 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12388 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12389 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12390 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12391 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12392 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12393 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12394 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12395 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012396 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012397 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12398 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12399 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12400 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12401 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12402 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012403 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012404
12405 Example:
12406 defaults
12407 # never fail on address resolution
12408 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012410inter <delay>
12411fastinter <delay>
12412downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012413 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12414 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12415 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12416 between checks depending on the server state :
12417
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012418 Server state | Interval used
12419 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12420 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12421 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12422 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12423 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12424 or yet unchecked. |
12425 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12426 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12427 | "inter" otherwise.
12428 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012430 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12431 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12432 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12433 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012434 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12435 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12436 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12437 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12438 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012439
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012440maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012441 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12442 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012443 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12444 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012445 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12446 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12447 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12448 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12449
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012450 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12451 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12452 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12453 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12454 than 50 concurrent requests.
12455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012456maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012457 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12458 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12459 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12460 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12461 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12462 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12463 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12464
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012465max-reuse <count>
12466 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12467 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12468 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12469 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12470 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12471 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12472 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12473 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012475minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012476 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12477 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12478 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12479 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12480 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12481 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012482 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012483 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012484
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012485namespace <name>
12486 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12487 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12488 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12489 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12490
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012491no-agent-check
12492 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12493 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12494 default value.
12495 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12496 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12497
12498no-backup
12499 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12500 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12501 default value.
12502 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12503 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12504
12505no-check
12506 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12507 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12508 default value.
12509 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12510 "default-server" "check" setting.
12511
12512no-check-ssl
12513 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12514 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12515 default value.
12516 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12517 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12518
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012519no-send-proxy
12520 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12521 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12522 default value.
12523 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12524 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12525
12526no-send-proxy-v2
12527 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12528 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12529 default value.
12530 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12531 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12532
12533no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12534 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12535 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12536 default value.
12537 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12538 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12539
12540no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12541 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12542 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12543 default value.
12544 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12545 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12546
12547no-ssl
12548 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12549 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12550 default value.
12551 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12552 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12553
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012554no-ssl-reuse
12555 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12556 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12557 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12558 and for paranoid users.
12559
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012560no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012561 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12562 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012563 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012564
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012565 Supported in default-server: No
12566
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012567no-tls-tickets
12568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12569 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12570 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012571 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12572 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012573 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12574 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12575 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012576 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012577
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012578no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012579 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012580 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12581 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012582 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12583 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012584 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012585
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012586 Supported in default-server: No
12587
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012588no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012589 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012590 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12591 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012592 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12593 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012594 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012595
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012596 Supported in default-server: No
12597
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012598no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012599 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012600 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12601 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012602 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12603 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012604 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012605
12606 Supported in default-server: No
12607
12608no-tlsv13
12609 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12610 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12611 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12612 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12613 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012614 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012615
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012616 Supported in default-server: No
12617
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012618no-verifyhost
12619 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12620 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12621 default value.
12622 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12623 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012624
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012625no-tfo
12626 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12627 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12628 default value.
12629 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12630 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12631
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012632non-stick
12633 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12634 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12635 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12636
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012637npn <protocols>
12638 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12639 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12640 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012641 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012642 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12643 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12644 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012646observe <mode>
12647 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12648 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12649 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12650 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12651 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12652 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012653 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012654
12655 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012657on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012658 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12659 Currently, four modes are available:
12660 - fastinter: force fastinter
12661 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12662 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12663 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12664 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12665
12666 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12667
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012668on-marked-down <action>
12669 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12670 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012671 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12672 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12673 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12674 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12675 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12676 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12677 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12678 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012679
12680 Actions are disabled by default
12681
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012682on-marked-up <action>
12683 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12684 Currently one action is available:
12685 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12686 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12687 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12688 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012689 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12690 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012691 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12692 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12693
12694 Actions are disabled by default
12695
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012696pool-max-conn <max>
12697 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12698 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12699 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12700 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12701 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12702 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12703
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012704pool-purge-delay <delay>
12705 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012706 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012707 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012708
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012709port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012710 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12711 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12712 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12713 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12714 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12715 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12716
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012717proto <name>
12718
12719 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12720 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12721 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12722 reported in haproxy -vv.
12723 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12724 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012726redir <prefix>
12727 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12728 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12729 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12730 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12731 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12732 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12733 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12734 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012735 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012737 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12738 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12739 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12740 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12741
12742 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012744rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012745 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12746 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12747 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12748
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012749resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12750 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12751 server.
12752
12753 Available options:
12754
12755 * allow-dup-ip
12756 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12757 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12758 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12759 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12760 For such case, simply enable this option.
12761 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12762
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012763 * ignore-weight
12764 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12765 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12766 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12767
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012768 * prevent-dup-ip
12769 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12770 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12771 same fqdn.
12772 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12773
12774 Example:
12775 backend b_myapp
12776 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12777 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12778 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12779
12780 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12781 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12782 it
12783 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12784 different address
12785
12786 Default value: not set
12787
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012788resolve-prefer <family>
12789 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12790 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12791 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12792 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12793
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012794 Default value: ipv6
12795
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012796 Example:
12797
12798 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012799
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012800resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012801 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012802 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012803 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012804 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12805 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012806 configured network, another address is selected.
12807
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012808 Example:
12809
12810 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012811
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012812resolvers <id>
12813 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12814 hostname.
12815
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012816 Example:
12817
12818 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012819
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012820 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012821
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012822send-proxy
12823 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12824 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12825 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12826 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012827 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12828 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12829 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12830 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12831 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12832 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12833 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12834 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12835 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12836 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012837 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12838 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012839
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012840send-proxy-v2
12841 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12842 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12843 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12844 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012845 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12846 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12847 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12848 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012849
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012850proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010012851 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
12852 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
12853
12854 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
12855 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
12856 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
12857 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
12858 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
12859 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
12860 connection is supported).
12861 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
12862 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
12863 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
12864 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
12865 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
12866 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
12867 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012868
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012869send-proxy-v2-ssl
12870 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12871 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12872 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12873 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12874 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12875 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12876 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012877 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12878 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012879
12880send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12881 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12882 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12883 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12884 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12885 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12886 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12887 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12888 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012889 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12890 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012892slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012893 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12894 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12895 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12896 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12897 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12898 parameters :
12899
12900 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12901 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12902
12903 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12904 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12905 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12906 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12907
12908 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12909 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12910 seen as failed.
12911
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012912sni <expression>
12913 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12914 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12915 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12916 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012917 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12918 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012919 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012920 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12921 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012922
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012923source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012924source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012925source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012926 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12927 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12928 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12929 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12930
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012931 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12932 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12933 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12934 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12935 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12936 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12937 server.
12938
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012939 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12940 specifying the source address without port(s).
12941
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012942ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012943 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12944 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12945 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12946 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12947 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12948 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012949 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12950 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012951
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012952ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12953 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12954 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12955 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12956
12957ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12958 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12959 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12960 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12961
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012962ssl-reuse
12963 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12964 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12965 default value.
12966 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12967 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12968
12969stick
12970 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12971 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12972 default value.
12973 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12974 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012975
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012976socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012977 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012978 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12979 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12980
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012981tcp-ut <delay>
12982 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12983 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12984 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012985 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012986 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12987 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12988 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12989 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12990 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12991 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12992 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12993 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12994 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12995
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012996tfo
12997 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12998 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12999 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13000 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13001 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013002 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013004track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013005 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13006 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13007 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13008 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013009 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13010
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013011tls-tickets
13012 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13013 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13014 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013015 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13016 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13017 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013018 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013019 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013020
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013021verify [none|required]
13022 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013023 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013024 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13025 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013026 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013027 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13028 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13029 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13030 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13031 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13032 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13033 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13034 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013035
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013036verifyhost <hostname>
13037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013038 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13039 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13040 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13041 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13042 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13043 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13044 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13045 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013047weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013048 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13049 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13050 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013051 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13052 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13053 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13054 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13055 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13056 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013057
13058
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130595.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13060-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013061
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013062HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13063using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13064configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013065This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13066can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13067workload.
13068This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13069resolution at run time.
13070Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13071carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13072
13073
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130745.3.1. Global overview
13075----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013076
13077As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13078different steps of the process life:
13079
13080 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13081 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13082 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13083
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013084 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13085 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013086
13087A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13088 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13089 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13090 resolution to know this new IP.
13091
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013092When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013093HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013094SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13095from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13096will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13097will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013098
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013099A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013100 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013101 first valid response.
13102
13103 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13104 servers return an error.
13105
13106
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200131075.3.2. The resolvers section
13108----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013109
13110This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013111HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13112contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013113
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013114When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13115uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13116is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13117answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13118
13119When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013120used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013121
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013122 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13123 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13124 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013125
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013126 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13127 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013128
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013129 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13130 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13131 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013132
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013133For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13134following scenarios are possible:
13135
13136 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13137 ignored
13138
13139 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13140 applied
13141
13142 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13143 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13144
13145 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13146 retries the query with a new type
13147
13148 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13149 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013150
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013151As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13152a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013153<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013154
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013155
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013156resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013157 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013158
13159A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13160
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013161accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013162 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013163 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013164 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13165 by RFC 6891)
13166
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013167 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13168
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013169nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13170 DNS server description:
13171 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13172 <ip> : IP address of the server
13173 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13174
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013175parse-resolv-conf
13176 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13177 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13178 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13179
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013180hold <status> <period>
13181 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13182 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013183 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013184 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013185 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13186 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13187 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13188
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013189 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013190
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013191resolve_retries <nb>
13192 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13193 giving up.
13194 Default value: 3
13195
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013196 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13197 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13198 type.
13199
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013200timeout <event> <time>
13201 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13202 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13203 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013204 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13205 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013206 Default value: 1s
13207 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013208 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013209 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013210 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13211 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13212
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013213 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013214
13215 resolvers mydns
13216 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13217 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013218 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013219 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013220 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013221 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013222 hold other 30s
13223 hold refused 30s
13224 hold nx 30s
13225 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013226 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013227 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013228
13229
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200132306. Cache
13231---------
13232
13233HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13234(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13235RAM.
13236
13237The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13238this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13239
13240If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13241independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13242when we try to allocate a new one.
13243
13244The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13245
13246It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13247"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13248for more details.
13249
13250When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13251replaced by "<CACHE>".
13252
13253
132546.1. Limitation
13255----------------
13256
13257The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13258
13259- If the response is not a 200
13260- If the response contains a Vary header
13261- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13262- If the response is not cacheable
13263
13264- If the request is not a GET
13265- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13266- If the request contains an Authorization header
13267
13268
132696.2. Setup
13270-----------
13271
13272To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13273the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13274
13275
132766.2.1. Cache section
13277---------------------
13278
13279cache <name>
13280 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13281 size of cache is mandatory.
13282
13283total-max-size <megabytes>
13284 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13285 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13286
13287max-object-size <bytes>
13288 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13289 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13290 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13291
13292max-age <seconds>
13293 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13294 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13295 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13296 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13297 default.
13298
13299
133006.2.2. Proxy section
13301---------------------
13302
13303http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13304 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13305 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13306 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13307 after this one.
13308
13309http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13310 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13311 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13312 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13313 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13314
13315
13316Example:
13317
13318 backend bck1
13319 mode http
13320
13321 http-request cache-use foobar
13322 http-response cache-store foobar
13323 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13324
13325 cache foobar
13326 total-max-size 4
13327 max-age 240
13328
13329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133307. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13331----------------------------------
13332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013333HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13335The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13336these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13337but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13338data called patterns.
13339
13340
133417.1. ACL basics
13342---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013343
13344The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13345content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13346from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13347simple :
13348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013349 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013350 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13352 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013354The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13355adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013356
13357In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013360
13361This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13362Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13363and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013364an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13365conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13366as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13367are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013368
13369ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13370'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13371which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13372
13373There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13374performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13377specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13378this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013379methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13380ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013381
13382Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13383 - boolean
13384 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13385 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13386 - string
13387 - data block
13388
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013389Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13390converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13391would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13392The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13393which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13394
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013395Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13396keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13397fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13398which are summarized in the table below :
13399
13400 +---------------------+-----------------+
13401 | Sample or converter | Default |
13402 | output type | matching method |
13403 +---------------------+-----------------+
13404 | boolean | bool |
13405 +---------------------+-----------------+
13406 | integer | int |
13407 +---------------------+-----------------+
13408 | ip | ip |
13409 +---------------------+-----------------+
13410 | string | str |
13411 +---------------------+-----------------+
13412 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13413 +---------------------+-----------------+
13414
13415Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13416matching method, see below.
13417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013418The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13419 - boolean
13420 - integer or integer range
13421 - IP address / network
13422 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13423 - regular expression
13424 - hex block
13425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013426The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13427
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013428 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13429 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013431 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013432 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013433 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013434 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013436The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13437read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13438if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13439lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13440will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13441beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13442a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13443lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13444exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13445
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013446The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13447parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13448ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13449a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13450check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13451
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013452The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13453socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13454file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13457loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13458
13459 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13460
13461In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13462the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13463case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13464as well.
13465
13466The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13467sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13468do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13469methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13470is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013471obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013472followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13473default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13474that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13475string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13476
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013477The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13478By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13479string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13480resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13481server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013482waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013483flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13484function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013486There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13487sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13488be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013489
13490 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13491 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013492 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13493 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13494 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13495 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013496
13497 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13498 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013500
13501 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013502 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013503
13504 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013506
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013507 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013508 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13509
13510 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13511 binary or string samples.
13512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13514 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013516 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13517 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13518 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13521 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013523 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13524 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013526 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13527 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13530 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013531 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13534 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13535 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013536
13537For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13538request, it is possible to do :
13539
13540 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13541
13542In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13543buffer, one would use the following acl :
13544
13545 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13546
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013547On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13548possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13549
13550 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013552All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13553criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13554method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13555to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13556criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13557the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013559If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013560the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13561For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013563 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13564 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13565 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13566 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013567
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013568
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013569The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13570types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13571combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13572brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13573default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013575 +-------------------------------------------------+
13576 | Input sample type |
13577 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013578 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013579 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13580 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13581 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013582 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013583 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013584 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013585 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013586 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013588 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013590 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013591 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013592 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013593 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013594 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013595 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013596 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013597 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013598 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013599 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013600 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013601 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013602 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013603 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13604 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13605 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013606
13607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136087.1.1. Matching booleans
13609------------------------
13610
13611In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13612Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13613When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13614that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13615
13616Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13617return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13618"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13619
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136217.1.2. Matching integers
13622------------------------
13623
13624Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13625enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13626to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13627
13628Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13629matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13630lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013631
13632For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13633unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13634representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13635
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013636As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13637two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13638instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13639ranges and operators.
13640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013641For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013642operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13643Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13644of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013645
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013646Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013647
13648 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13649 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13650 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13651 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13652 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13653
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013654For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013655
13656 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13657
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013658This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13659
13660 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136637.1.3. Matching strings
13664-----------------------
13665
13666String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13667different forms :
13668
13669 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013670 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671
13672 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013673 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013674
13675 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13676 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13677
13678 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13679 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13680
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013681 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013682 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13683 matches.
13684
13685 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13686 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13687 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013688
13689String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13690exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13691characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13692string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13693to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013694before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013695
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013696Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13697(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13698Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13699
13700Example:
13701 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13702 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137057.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13706---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013707
13708Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13709they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13710possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13711passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13712the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013713the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13714match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013715
13716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200137177.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13718-------------------------------------
13719
13720It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13721not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13722a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13723to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13724digits may be used upper or lower case.
13725
13726Example :
13727 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13728 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13729
13730
137317.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13732---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013733
13734IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13735netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13736within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013737host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013738difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13739at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13740does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13741parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013742
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013743The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13744abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13745
13746 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13747 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13748 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13749 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13750 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13751 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13752 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13753 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13754
13755Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13756192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13757
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013758IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13759Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13760trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13761IPv6 patterns.
13762
13763HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13764following situations :
13765 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13766 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13767 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13768 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13769 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13770 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13771 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13772 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13773 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13774 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013776
137777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13778----------------------------------
13779
13780Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13781combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13782
13783 - AND (implicit)
13784 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13785 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013787A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013789 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13792indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013794For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13795"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13796requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13797is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13798
13799 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013800 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13801 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13802 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013803
13804To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13805and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13806
13807 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13808 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13809 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13810 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13811
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013812 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013813 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13814 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13815 use_backend www if host_www
13816
13817It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13818expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13819be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13820the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13821
13822 The following rule :
13823
13824 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013825 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013826
13827 Can also be written that way :
13828
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013829 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830
13831It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13832to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13833simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13834sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13835good use is the following :
13836
13837 With named ACLs :
13838
13839 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13840 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13841 monitor fail if site_dead
13842
13843 With anonymous ACLs :
13844
13845 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13846
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013847See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13848keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849
13850
138517.3. Fetching samples
13852---------------------
13853
13854Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13855against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13856sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13857ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13858of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13859available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13860
13861This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13862Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13863compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13864deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13865
13866The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13867matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13868method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13869indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13870
13871As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13872when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13873mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13874the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13875ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13876
13877Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13878multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13879when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013880incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13881are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013882is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13883all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13884
13885Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13886 - name
13887 - name(arg1)
13888 - name(arg1,arg2)
13889
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013890
138917.3.1. Converters
13892-----------------
13893
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013894Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13895of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13896is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13897was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013898has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013899unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13900
13901These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13902sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13903the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013904support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013905
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013906A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13907support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13908supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13909(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13910bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013912The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013913
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001391451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13915 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13916 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13917 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13918 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13919 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13920
13921 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013922 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13923 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013924 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13925 frontend http-in
13926 bind *:8081
13927 default_backend servers
13928 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13929 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13930
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013931add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013932 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013933 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013934 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13935 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013936 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13938 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13939 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13940 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013941 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013942 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013943
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013944aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13945 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13946 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13947 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13948 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13949 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13950 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13951
13952 Example:
13953 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13954 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13955
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013956and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013957 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013958 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013959 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13960 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013961 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013962 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13963 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13964 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013967 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013968
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013969b64dec
13970 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13971 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13972
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013973base64
13974 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013975 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013976 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13977
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013978bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013979 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013980 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013981 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013982 presence of a flag).
13983
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013984bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13985 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13986 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013987 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013988
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013989concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13990 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13991 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13992 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13993 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13994 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13995 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13996 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13997 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13998 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13999 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014000 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14001 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14002 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14003 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014004
14005 Example:
14006 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14007 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14008 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014009 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014010 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14011
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014012cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014013 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14014 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014015
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014016crc32([<avalanche>])
14017 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14018 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14019 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14020 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14021 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14022 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14023 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14024 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14025 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14026 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014027 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14028
14029crc32c([<avalanche>])
14030 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14031 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14032 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14033 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14034 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14035 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14036 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14037 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014038
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014039cut_crlf
14040 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14041 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14042 updated.
14043
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014044da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014045 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14046 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14047 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14048 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014049 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014050 configuration language.
14051
14052 Example:
14053 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014054 bind *:8881
14055 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014056 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014057
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014058debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14059 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14060 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14061 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14062 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14063 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14064 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14065 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14066 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14067 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14068 printable sample types.
14069
14070 Example:
14071 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014072
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014073div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014074 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14075 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014076 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014077 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14078 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014079 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014080 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14081 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14082 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14083 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014084 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014085 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014086
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014087djb2([<avalanche>])
14088 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14089 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14090 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14091 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14092 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14093 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14094 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014095 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14096 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014097
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014098even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014099 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014100 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14101
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014102field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14103 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14104 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14105 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14106 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14107 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14108 fields.
14109
14110 Example :
14111 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14112 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14113 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14114 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14115 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014116
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014117hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014118 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014119 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014120 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014121 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014122
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014123hex2i
14124 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014125 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014126
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014127htonl
14128 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14129 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14130 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14131 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14132
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014133http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014134 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14135 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014136 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14137 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14138 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14139 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14140 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14141 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14142 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14143 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014145in_table(<table>)
14146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14148 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014149 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014150 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14151
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014152ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14153 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014154 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014155 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14156 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14157 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14158 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14159 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014160
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014161json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014162 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014163 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014164 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014165 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14166 of errors:
14167 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14168 bytes, ...)
14169 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14170 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14171
14172 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14173 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14174 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14175 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14176 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14177 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014178 - "ascii" : never fails;
14179 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14180 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014181 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014182 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014183 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14184 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14185
14186 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014187 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014188
14189 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014190 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014191 capture request header user-agent len 150
14192 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014193
14194 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14195 GET / HTTP/1.0
14196 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14197
14198 Output log:
14199 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14200
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014201language(<value>[,<default>])
14202 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14203 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14204 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14205 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14206 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14207 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14208 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14209 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14210 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014211 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014212 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14213 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014215 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014216
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014217 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14218 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014219
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014220 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14221 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14222 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14223 use_backend spanish if es
14224 use_backend french if fr
14225 use_backend english if en
14226 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014227
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014228length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014229 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14230 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14231 type. The result is of type integer.
14232
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014233lower
14234 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14235 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14236 type. The result is of type string.
14237
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014238ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14239 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14240 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14241 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14242 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14243 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14244 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14245
14246 Example :
14247
14248 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014249 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014250 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14251
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014252ltrim(<chars>)
14253 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14254 representation of the input sample.
14255
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014256map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14257map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14258map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14259 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14260 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14261 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14262 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14263 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14264 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14265 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14266 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014267
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014268 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14269 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14270 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014271
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014272 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014273 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014274
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014275 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14276 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14277 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14278 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014279 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14280 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014281 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14282 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14283 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14284 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14285 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14286 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14287 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14288 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014289 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14290 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14291 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014292 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14293 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14294 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14295 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14296 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014297
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014298 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14299 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14300 the corresponding match text.
14301
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014302 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14303 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14304 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14305 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14306 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014307
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014308 Example :
14309
14310 # this is a comment and is ignored
14311 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14312 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14313 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14314 | | | `---------- value
14315 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14316 | `---------------------------- key
14317 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14318
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014319mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014320 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14321 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014322 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014323 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014324 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014325 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14326 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14327 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14328 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014330 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014331
14332mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014333 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014334 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14335 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014336 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014337 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014338 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014339 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14340 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14341 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14342 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014343 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014344 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014345
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014346nbsrv
14347 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14348 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14349 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14350 map lookup.
14351
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014352neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014353 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14354 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14355 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14356 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014357
14358not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014359 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014360 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014361 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014362 absence of a flag).
14363
14364odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014365 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014366 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14367
14368or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014369 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014370 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014371 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14372 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014373 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014374 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14375 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14376 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14377 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014378 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014379 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014380
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014381protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14382 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14383 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14384 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14385 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14386 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14387 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14388 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14389 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14390 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14391 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14392 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14393
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014394regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014395 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14396 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14397 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14398 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14399 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14400 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14401 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14402 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14403 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014404 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
14405 of characters with other ones.
14406
14407 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
14408 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
14409 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
14410 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
14411 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
14412 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014413
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014414 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014415
14416 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14417 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14418 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014419 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014420
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010014421 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
14422 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
14423
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010014424 # capture groups and backreferences
14425 # both lines do the same.
14426 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
14427 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
14428
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014429capture-req(<id>)
14430 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14431 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14432
14433 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014434 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14435 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014436
14437capture-res(<id>)
14438 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14439 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14440
14441 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014442 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14443 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014444
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014445sdbm([<avalanche>])
14446 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14447 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14448 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14449 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14450 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14451 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14452 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014453 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14454 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014455
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014456set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014457 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14458 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14459 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014460 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014461 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14462 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014463 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014464 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14465 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014466 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014467 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014468
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014469sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014470 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014471 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14472
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020014473sha2([<bits>])
14474 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
14475 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
14476
14477 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
14478 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
14479
14480 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14481 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14482
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020014483srv_queue
14484 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
14485 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
14486 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
14487 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
14488 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
14489
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014490strcmp(<var>)
14491 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14492 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14493 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14494 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14495 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14496 shorter).
14497
14498 Example :
14499
14500 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14501 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14502 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14503
14504
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014505sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014506 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14507 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014508 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014509 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14510 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014511 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014512 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14513 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014514 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014515 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14516 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014517 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014518 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014519
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014520table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14521 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14522 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14523 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14524 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14525 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14526 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14527
14528
14529table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14530 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14531 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14532 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14533 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14534 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14535 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14536
14537table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14538 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14539 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014540 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014541 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14542 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14543
14544table_conn_cur(<table>)
14545 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14546 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14547 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14548 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14549 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14550
14551table_conn_rate(<table>)
14552 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14553 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14554 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14555 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14556 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14557
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014558table_gpt0(<table>)
14559 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14560 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14561 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14562 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14563 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14564
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014565table_gpc0(<table>)
14566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14568 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14569 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14570 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14571
14572table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14573 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14574 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14575 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14576 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14577 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14578 sample fetch keyword.
14579
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014580table_gpc1(<table>)
14581 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14582 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14583 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14584 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14585 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14586
14587table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14588 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14589 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14590 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14591 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14592 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14593 sample fetch keyword.
14594
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014595table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14596 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14597 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014598 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014599 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14600 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14601
14602table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14603 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14604 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14605 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14606 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14607 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14608 keyword.
14609
14610table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014614 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14615 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14616
14617table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14620 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14621 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14622 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14623 keyword.
14624
14625table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014628 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014629 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14630 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14631 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14632 keyword.
14633
14634table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14635 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14636 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014637 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014638 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14639 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14640 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14641 keyword.
14642
14643table_server_id(<table>)
14644 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14645 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14646 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14647 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14648 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14649 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14650
14651table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14652 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14653 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014654 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014655 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14656 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14657 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14658 keyword.
14659
14660table_sess_rate(<table>)
14661 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14662 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14663 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14664 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14665 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14666 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14667 keyword.
14668
14669table_trackers(<table>)
14670 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14671 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14672 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14673 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14674 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14675 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14676 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14677 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14678 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14679 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14680
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014681upper
14682 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14683 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14684 type. The result is of type string.
14685
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014686url_dec([<in_form>])
14687 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14688 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14689 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14690 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14691 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14692 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014693
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014694ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014695 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014696 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14697 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14698 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014699 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14700 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14701 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14702 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014703 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014704 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14705 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014706
14707 Example:
14708 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14709 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14710
14711 message Point {
14712 int32 latitude = 1;
14713 int32 longitude = 2;
14714 }
14715
14716 message PPoint {
14717 Point point = 59;
14718 }
14719
14720 message Rectangle {
14721 // One corner of the rectangle.
14722 PPoint lo = 48;
14723 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14724 PPoint hi = 49;
14725 }
14726
14727 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14728 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14729 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14730
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014731 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14732 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014733 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014734 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14735
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014736 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014737
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014738 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014739
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014740 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014741 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14742 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14743
14744 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14745 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14746 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14747
14748 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14749 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14750 interpret the previous binary sample.
14751
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014752
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014753unset-var(<var name>)
14754 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14755 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14758 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14759 response),
14760 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14761 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14762 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14763 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14764
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014765utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14766 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14767 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14768 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14769 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14770 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14771 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14772
14773 Example :
14774
14775 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014776 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014777 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14778
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014779word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14780 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14781 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14782 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014783 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014784 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14785 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14786
14787 Example :
14788 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14789 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14790 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14791 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14792 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014793 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014794
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014795wt6([<avalanche>])
14796 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14797 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14798 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14799 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14800 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14801 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14802 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014803 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14804 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014805
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014806xor(<value>)
14807 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014808 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014809 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014810 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014811 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014812 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14813 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014814 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014815 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14816 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014817 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014818 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014819
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014820xxh32([<seed>])
14821 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14822 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14823 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14824 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14825 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14826 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14827 as cryptographically secure.
14828
14829xxh64([<seed>])
14830 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14831 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14832 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14833 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14834 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14835 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14836 as cryptographically secure.
14837
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014838
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148397.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014840--------------------------------------------
14841
14842A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14843not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14844"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14845The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14846
14847always_false : boolean
14848 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14849 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14850
14851always_true : boolean
14852 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14853 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14854
14855avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014856 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14858 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14859 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14860 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14861 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14862 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14863 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14864 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14865 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14866 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14867 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14868 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14869 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014872 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14873 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14874 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14875 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014876 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14877
14878be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14879 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14880 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14881 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14882 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14883 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014884 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14885 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014886
14887 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14888 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14889 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014891be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14892 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14893 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14894 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014895 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014896 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14897 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014898
14899 Example :
14900 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14901 backend dynamic
14902 mode http
14903 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14904 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014905
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014906bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014907 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14908 of the string.
14909
14910bool(<bool>) : bool
14911 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14912 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14915 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014916 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014917 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14918 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014919
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014920 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014921 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014922 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14923
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014924 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14925 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014926
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014927 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014928 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014930 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014931 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014933 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014934
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014935 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14936 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014938 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014939
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014940cpu_calls : integer
14941 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14942 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14943 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14944 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14945 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14946 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14947
14948cpu_ns_avg : integer
14949 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14950 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14951 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14952 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14953 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14954 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14955 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14956 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14957 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14958 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14959 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14960
14961cpu_ns_tot : integer
14962 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14963 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14964 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14965 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14966 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14967 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14968 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14969 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14970 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14971 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14972 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14973 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14974 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14975
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014976date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014977 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014978
14979 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14980 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14981 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014982 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14983
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014984 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14985 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14986 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14987 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14988 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14989
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014990 Example :
14991
14992 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14993 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014994
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014995 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14996 # millisecond granularity
14997 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14998
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014999date_us : integer
15000 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15001 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15002 from the same timeval structure.
15003
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015004distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15005 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15006 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15007 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15008 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15009 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15010 list of supported tokens.
15011
15012distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15013 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15014 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15015 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15016 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15017 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15018 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15019 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15020 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15021 supported tokens.
15022
15023 Example :
15024 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15025 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15026 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15027 # send large files to the big farm
15028 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15029
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015030env(<name>) : string
15031 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15032 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15033 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15034 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15035 certain way.
15036
15037 Examples :
15038 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15039 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15040
15041 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15042 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15045 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015046 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15047 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015048 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15049 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015050 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15052 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015053
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015054fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15055 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15056 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15057 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15060 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15061 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15062 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15063 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15064 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15065 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15066 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15067 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015068
15069 Example :
15070 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15071 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15072 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15073 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15074 frontend mail
15075 bind :25
15076 mode tcp
15077 maxconn 100
15078 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15079 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15080 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15081 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015082
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015083hostname : string
15084 Returns the system hostname.
15085
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015086int(<integer>) : signed integer
15087 Returns a signed integer.
15088
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015089ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15090 Returns an ipv4.
15091
15092ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15093 Returns an ipv6.
15094
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015095lat_ns_avg : integer
15096 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15097 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15098 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15099 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15100 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15101 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15102 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15103 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15104 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15105 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15106 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15107 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15108 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15109 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15110
15111lat_ns_tot : integer
15112 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15113 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15114 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15115 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15116 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15117 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15118 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15119 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15120 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15121 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15122 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15123 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15124 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15125 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15126 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15127 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15128 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15129 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15130 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15131
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015132meth(<method>) : method
15133 Returns a method.
15134
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015135nbproc : integer
15136 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15137 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15138 and debugging purposes.
15139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15141 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15142 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15143 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015144 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15145 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15146 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015147
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015148prio_class : integer
15149 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15150 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15151 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15152
15153prio_offset : integer
15154 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15155 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15156 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15157 set-priority-offset".
15158
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015159proc : integer
15160 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15161 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15162 debugging purposes.
15163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015165 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15166 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15167 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15169 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15170 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15171 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15172 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15173
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015174rand([<range>]) : integer
15175 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15176 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15177 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15178 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15179 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15180
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015181uuid([<version>]) : string
15182 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15183 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15184 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015186srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15187 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15188 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15189 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15190 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15191 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015192 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15193 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15194
15195srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15196 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15197 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15198 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15199 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15200 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15201 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15202 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15203
15204 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15205 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206
15207srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15208 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15209 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15210 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015211 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015212 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15213 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15214 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15215
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015216srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15217 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15218 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15219 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15220 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15221 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15222 fetch methods.
15223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015224srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15225 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15226 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015227 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15229 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015230 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231 overloading servers).
15232
15233 Example :
15234 # Redirect to a separate back
15235 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15236 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15237 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15238
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015239stopping : boolean
15240 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15241 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15242 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15243
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015244str(<string>) : string
15245 Returns a string.
15246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015247table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15248 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15249 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15250
15251table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15252 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15253 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15254 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15255
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015256thread : integer
15257 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15258 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15259 and debugging purposes.
15260
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015261var(<var-name>) : undefined
15262 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015263 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15264 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015265 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015266 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15267 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015268 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015269 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15270 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015271 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015272 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015273
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275----------------------------------
15276
15277The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15278closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15279methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15280sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15281TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015282the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15283counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015284"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15285used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15286can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15287Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15288table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15289tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15290currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015291
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015292bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015293 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15294 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15295 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015297be_id : integer
15298 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15299 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15300
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015301be_name : string
15302 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15303 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015305dst : ip
15306 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15307 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15308 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15309 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015310 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15311 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15312 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15313 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15314 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15315 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316
15317dst_conn : integer
15318 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15319 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15320 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15321 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15322 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15323 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15324 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15325 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015326
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015327dst_is_local : boolean
15328 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15329 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15330 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15331 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015332 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015333 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15334 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15335 it only once per connection.
15336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015337dst_port : integer
15338 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15339 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15340 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15341 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15342 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15343 an HTTP header.
15344
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015345fc_http_major : integer
15346 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15347 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15348 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15349
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020015350fc_pp_authority : string
15351 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15352 if any.
15353
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010015354fc_pp_unique_id : string
15355 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
15356 if any.
15357
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015358fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15359 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15360 header.
15361
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015362fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15363 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15364 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15365 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15366 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15367 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15368 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15369
15370fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15371 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15372 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15373 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15374 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15375 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15376 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15377
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015378fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015379 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15380 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15381 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15382 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15383
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015384fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015385 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15386 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15387 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15388 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15389
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015390fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015391 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15392 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15393 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15394 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15395
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015396fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015397 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15398 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15399 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15400 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15401
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015402fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015403 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15404 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15405 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15406 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15407
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015408fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015409 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15410 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15411 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15412 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15413
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015414fe_defbe : string
15415 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15416 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015418fe_id : integer
15419 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015420 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15422
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015423fe_name : string
15424 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15425 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15426 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15427
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015428sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015429sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15430sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15431sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015432 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15433 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15434 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015436sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015437sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15438sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15439sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015440 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15441 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15442 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015444sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015445sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15446sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15447sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015448 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15449 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015450 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15451 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15452 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015453
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015454 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015455 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15456 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015457 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15458 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15459 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015460 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15461 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15462
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015463sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15464sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15465sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15466sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15467 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15468 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15469 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15470 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15471 when a first ACL was verified.
15472
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015473sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015474sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15475sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15476sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015477 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015478 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15479
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015480sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015481sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15482sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15483sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015484 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15485 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15486 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15487
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015488sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015489sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15490sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15491sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015492 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15493 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15494 See also src_conn_rate.
15495
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015496sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015497sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15498sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15499sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015500 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015501 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015502
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015503sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15504sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15505sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15506sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15507 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15508 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15509
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015510sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15511sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15512sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15513sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15514 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15515 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15516
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015517sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015518sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15519sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15520sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015521 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15522 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15523 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015524 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15525 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15526 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015527
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015528sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15529sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15530sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15531sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15532 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15533 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15534 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15535 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15536 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15537 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15538
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015539sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015540sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15541sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15542sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015543 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015544 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15545 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15546
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015547sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015548sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15549sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15550sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015551 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15552 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15553 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15554 src_http_err_rate.
15555
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015556sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015557sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15558sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15559sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015560 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015561 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15562 src_http_req_cnt.
15563
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015564sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015565sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15566sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15567sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015568 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15569 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15570 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15571 src_http_req_rate.
15572
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015573sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015574sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15575sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15576sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015577 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015578 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15579 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15580 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15581 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015582
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015583 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015584 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15585 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015586 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15587
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015588sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15589sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15590sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15591sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15592 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15593 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15594 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15595 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15596 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15597
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015598sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015599sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15600sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15601sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015602 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15603 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15604 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015605
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015606sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015607sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15608sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15609sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015610 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15611 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15612 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015613
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015614sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015615sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15616sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15617sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015618 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015619 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15620 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15621 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015622 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015623 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15624
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015625sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015626sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15627sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15628sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015629 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15630 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15631 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15632 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15633 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015634 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015635
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015636sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015637sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15638sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15639sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015640 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15641 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15642 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015644sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015645sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15646sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15647sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015648 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15649 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015650 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015651 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15652 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15654 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15655 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657so_id : integer
15658 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15659 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15660 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015661
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015662so_name : string
15663 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15664 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15665 strings instead of integers.
15666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015667src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015668 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15670 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15671 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015672 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15673 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15674 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015675 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15676 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15677 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15678 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15679 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15680 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15681 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015682
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015683 Example:
15684 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15685 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15688 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15689 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15690 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015691 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15694 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15695 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015696 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015697 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15700 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15701 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15702 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15703 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15704 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15705 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015706
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015707 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015708 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15709 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15710 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15711 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015712 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015713 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15714 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15715
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015716src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15717 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15718 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15719 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15720 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15721 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15722 was verified.
15723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015725 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015727 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015728 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015731 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15733 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015734 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15737 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15738 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15739 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015740 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015743 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015745 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015746 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015747
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015748src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15749 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15750 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15751 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15752 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15753
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015754src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15755 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15756 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15757 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15758 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015761 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015763 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15764 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015765 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15766 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15767 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015768
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015769src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15770 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15771 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15772 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15773 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15774 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15775 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15776 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015778src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015779 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015781 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015782 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15786 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15787 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15788 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15789 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015790 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015793 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15795 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015796 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15799 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15800 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15801 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015802 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015803 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15806 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15807 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15808 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015809 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15811 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015812
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015813 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015814 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015815 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015816 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015817
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015818src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15819 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15820 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15821 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15822 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15823 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15824 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15825
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015826src_is_local : boolean
15827 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15828 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15829 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15830 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015831 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015832 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15833 once per connection.
15834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015835src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015836 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15837 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15838 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15839 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15840 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015842src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015843 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15844 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15845 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15846 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15847 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015849src_port : integer
15850 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15851 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15852 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15853 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015856 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015857 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15858 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15859 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015860 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015862src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15863 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15864 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15865 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15866 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015867 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015869src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15870 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15871 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15872 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15873 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15874 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15875 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15876 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15877 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015878
15879 Example :
15880 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15881 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15882 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15883 listen ssh
15884 bind :22
15885 mode tcp
15886 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015887 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015889 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891srv_id : integer
15892 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15893 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15894 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015895
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015896srv_name : string
15897 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15898 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15899 debugging.
15900
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159017.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15905closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15906when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15907usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015908future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015909
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001591051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15911 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15912 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15913 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15914 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15915 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15916
15917 Example :
15918 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15919 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15920 # the request.
15921 frontend http-in
15922 bind *:8081
15923 default_backend servers
15924 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15925 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15926
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015927ssl_bc : boolean
15928 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15929 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15930 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15931
15932ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15933 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15934 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15935
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015936ssl_bc_alpn : string
15937 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15938 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015939 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015940 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15941 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15942 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15943 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15944 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15945 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15946
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015947ssl_bc_cipher : string
15948 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15949 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15950
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015951ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15952 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15953 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15954 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15955
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015956ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15957 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15958 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15959 session or a TLS ticket.
15960
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015961ssl_bc_npn : string
15962 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15963 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015964 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015965 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15966 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15967 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15968 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15969 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15970
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015971ssl_bc_protocol : string
15972 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15973 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15974
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015975ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015976 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015977 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15978 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015979
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015980ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15981 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15982 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15983 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15984
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015985ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15986 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15987 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15988 if session was reused or not.
15989
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015990ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15991 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15992 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15993 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15994 BoringSSL.
15995
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015996ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15997 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15998 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016000ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16001 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16002 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16003 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16004 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16005 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16008 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16009 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16010 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16011 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016012
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016013ssl_c_der : binary
16014 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16015 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16016 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018ssl_c_err : integer
16019 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16020 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16021 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16022 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16023 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016024
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016025ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16027 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16028 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16029 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16030 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16031 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16032 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16033 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016034 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16035 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16036 LDAP v3.
16037 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16038 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040ssl_c_key_alg : string
16041 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16042 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16043 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016045ssl_c_notafter : string
16046 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16047 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16048 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016050ssl_c_notbefore : string
16051 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16052 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16053 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016054
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016055ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016056 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16057 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16058 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16059 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16060 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16061 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16062 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16063 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016064 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16065 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16066 LDAP v3.
16067 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16068 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016070ssl_c_serial : binary
16071 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16072 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16073 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016075ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16076 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16077 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16078 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016079 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16080 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16081
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016082 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016083 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16086 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16087 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16088 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090ssl_c_used : boolean
16091 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16092 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094ssl_c_verify : integer
16095 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16096 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16097 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16098 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100ssl_c_version : integer
16101 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16102 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016103
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016104ssl_f_der : binary
16105 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16106 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16107 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16108
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016109ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16111 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16112 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16113 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016114 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16116 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16117 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016118 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16119 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16120 LDAP v3.
16121 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16122 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124ssl_f_key_alg : string
16125 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16126 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16127 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129ssl_f_notafter : string
16130 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16131 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16132 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134ssl_f_notbefore : string
16135 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16136 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16137 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016138
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016139ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16141 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16142 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16143 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16144 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16145 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16146 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16147 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016148 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16149 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16150 LDAP v3.
16151 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16152 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154ssl_f_serial : binary
16155 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16156 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16157 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016158
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016159ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16160 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16161 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16162 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16165 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16166 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16167 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169ssl_f_version : integer
16170 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16171 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16172
16173ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016174 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16175 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16176 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178 Example :
16179 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16180 listen http-https
16181 bind :80
16182 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16183 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16184
16185ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16186 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16187 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16188
16189ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016190 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016191 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16192 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16193 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16194 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16195 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16196 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16197 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16198 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200ssl_fc_cipher : string
16201 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16202 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016203
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016204ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16205 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16206 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016207 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016208
16209ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16210 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16211 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016212 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016213
16214ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16215 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16216 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16217 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016218 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016219 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016220
16221ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16222 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16223 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016224 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016225
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016226ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16227 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16228 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16229 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016232 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16233 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016234 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16235 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16236 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16237 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016238
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016239ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16240 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16241 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16242 wait until the handshake happened.
16243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016244ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16245 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016246 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16247 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016248 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016249 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016250
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016251ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016252 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016253 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16254 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016256ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016257 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016258 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16259 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16260 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16261 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16262 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16263 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16264 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266ssl_fc_protocol : string
16267 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16268 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016269
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016270ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016271 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016272 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16273 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016274
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016275ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16276 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16277 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16278 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016280ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16281 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16282 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16283 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16284 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016285
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016286ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16287 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16288 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16289 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16290 BoringSSL.
16291
16292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016293ssl_fc_sni : string
16294 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16295 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16296 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16297 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16298 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16299
16300 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16301 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16302 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016303 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016304 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016307 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16308 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16311 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16312 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016313
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016314
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163157.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016318Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16319sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16320only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16321For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16322be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16323can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16324sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16325for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16326content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016328payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016329 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16331 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16334 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016335 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016336 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016337
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016338req.hdrs : string
16339 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16340 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16341 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16342 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16343
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016344req.hdrs_bin : binary
16345 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16346 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16347 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16348 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16349 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16350 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16351
16352 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16353
16354 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16355 str: <int:length><bytes>
16356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016357req.len : integer
16358req_len : integer (deprecated)
16359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16360 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16361 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16362 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16363 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16364 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16365 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16366 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016368req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16369 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016370 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16371 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16372 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16373 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375 ACL alternatives :
16376 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016378req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16379 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16380 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16381 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16382 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384 ACL alternatives :
16385 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016389req.proto_http : boolean
16390req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16391 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16392 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16393 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16394 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16395 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16396 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16397 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016399 Example:
16400 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16401 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16402 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016403 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16406rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16407 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16408 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16409 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16410 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16411 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16412 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16413 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016415 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16416 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16417 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16418 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16419 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16420 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016422 ACL derivatives :
16423 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016425 Example :
16426 listen tse-farm
16427 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16428 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16429 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16430 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16431 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16432 persist rdp-cookie
16433 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16434 # This is only useful makes sense if
16435 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16436 stick-table type string size 204800
16437 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16438 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16439 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016441 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16442 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016444req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16445rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16446 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16447 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16448 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16449 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451 ACL derivatives :
16452 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016453
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016454req.ssl_alpn : string
16455 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16456 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16457 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16458 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16459 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16460 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016461 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016462
16463 Examples :
16464 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16465 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16466 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016467 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016468 default_backend bk_default
16469
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016470req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16471 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16472 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016473 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16474 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16475 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16476 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16477 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016479req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16480req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16481 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16482 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16483 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16484 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16485 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16486 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16487 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489req.ssl_sni : string
16490req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16491 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16492 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16493 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16494 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16495 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16496 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16497 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16498 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16499 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16500 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16501 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16502 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504 ACL derivatives :
16505 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016507 Examples :
16508 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16509 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16510 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16511 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16512 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016513
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016514req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16515 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16516 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16517 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16518 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16519 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16520 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16521 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16522 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16523 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525req.ssl_ver : integer
16526req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16527 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16528 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16529 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16530 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16531 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16532 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16533 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016534 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016537 ACL derivatives :
16538 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016539
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016540res.len : integer
16541 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16542 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16543 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16544 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16545 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16546 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16547 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16548 content inspection.
16549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16551 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016552 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16553 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16554 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16555 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16558 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16559 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16560 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16561 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016563 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016564
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016565res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16566rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16567 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16568 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16569 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16570 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16571 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16572 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16573 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016575wait_end : boolean
16576 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16577 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016578 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016579 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16580 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016581 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16583 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585 Examples :
16586 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16587 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16588 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16591 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16592 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16593 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16594 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16595 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16596 tcp-request content reject
16597
16598
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200165997.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600--------------------------------------
16601
16602It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16603This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16604data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16605its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16606HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16607content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16608to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16609more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16610response are indexed.
16611
16612base : string
16613 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16614 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16615 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16616 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16617 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16618 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16619 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16620 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16621
16622 ACL derivatives :
16623 base : exact string match
16624 base_beg : prefix match
16625 base_dir : subdir match
16626 base_dom : domain match
16627 base_end : suffix match
16628 base_len : length match
16629 base_reg : regex match
16630 base_sub : substring match
16631
16632base32 : integer
16633 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16634 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16635 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016636 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16637 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16638 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016639
16640base32+src : binary
16641 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16642 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16643 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16644 per-URL counters.
16645
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016646capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16647 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16648 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16649 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16650
16651capture.req.method : string
16652 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16653 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16654 because it's allocated.
16655
16656capture.req.uri : string
16657 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16658 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16659 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16660 allocated.
16661
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016662capture.req.ver : string
16663 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16664 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16665 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16666
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016667capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16668 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16669 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16670 The first entry is an index of 0.
16671 See also: "capture response header"
16672
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016673capture.res.ver : string
16674 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16675 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16676 persistent flag.
16677
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016678req.body : binary
16679 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16680 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16681 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16682 the first chunk is analyzed.
16683
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016684req.body_param([<name>) : string
16685 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16686 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16687 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16688 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16689 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16690 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16691 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16692 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16693 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16694 given.
16695
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016696req.body_len : integer
16697 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16698 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16699 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16700 "option http-buffer-request".
16701
16702req.body_size : integer
16703 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16704 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16705 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16706 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16707 "option http-buffer-request".
16708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709req.cook([<name>]) : string
16710cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16711 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16712 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16713 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16714 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16715 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16716 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16717 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16718 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16719
16720 ACL derivatives :
16721 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16722 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16723 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16724 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16725 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16726 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16727 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16728 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16731cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16732 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16733 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16736cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16737 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16738 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16739 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16740 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016742cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16743 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16744 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16745 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16746 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016747 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016748 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16749 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16750 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16751 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016753hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16754 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16755 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16756 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16757 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016758 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016760req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16761 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16762 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16763 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16764 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16765 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16766 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16767 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16768 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16771 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16772 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16773 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16774 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16777 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16778 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16779 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16780 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16781 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16782 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16783 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16784 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016785 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016787 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016789 ACL derivatives :
16790 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16791 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16792 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16793 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16794 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16795 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16796 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16797 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16798
16799req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16800hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16801 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16802 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16803 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16804 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16805 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16806 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16807 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16808 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16809 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16810
16811req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16812hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16813 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16814 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16815 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16816 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16817 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016818 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16820 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16821
16822req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16823hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16824 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16825 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16826 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16827 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16828 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16829 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16830 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16831
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016832
16833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16835 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16836 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16837 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16838 basic auth is supported.
16839
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016840http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16841 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16842 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16843 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16844 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016845 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16846 basic auth is supported.
16847
16848 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016849 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16850 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16851 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16852 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016853
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016854http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016855 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16856 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16857 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016858
16859http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016860 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16861 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16862 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016863
16864http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010016865 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16866 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16867 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016870 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16871 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016872 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16873 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875method : integer + string
16876 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16877 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16878 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16879 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16880 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16881 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16882 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884 ACL derivatives :
16885 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016887 Example :
16888 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16889 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16890 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892path : string
16893 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16894 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16895 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16896 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16897 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016898 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016901 ACL derivatives :
16902 path : exact string match
16903 path_beg : prefix match
16904 path_dir : subdir match
16905 path_dom : domain match
16906 path_end : suffix match
16907 path_len : length match
16908 path_reg : regex match
16909 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016910
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016911query : string
16912 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16913 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16914 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16915 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016916 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016917 which stops before the question mark.
16918
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016919req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16920 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16921 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16922 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16923 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925req.ver : string
16926req_ver : string (deprecated)
16927 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16928 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16929 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016931 ACL derivatives :
16932 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016934res.comp : boolean
16935 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16936 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16937 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016939res.comp_algo : string
16940 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16941 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16942 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944res.cook([<name>]) : string
16945scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16946 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16947 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16948 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016950 ACL derivatives :
16951 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016953res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16954scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16955 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16956 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16957 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016959res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16960scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16961 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16962 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16963 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016965res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16966 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16967 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16968 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16969 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16970 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16971 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16972 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16973 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16974 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016976res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16977 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16978 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16979 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16980 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16981 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016983res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16984shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16985 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16986 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16987 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16988 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16989 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16990 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16991 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16992 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016994 ACL derivatives :
16995 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16996 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16997 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16998 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16999 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17000 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17001 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17002 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17003
17004res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17005shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17006 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17007 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17008 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17009 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
17010 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017012res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17013shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17014 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17015 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17016 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17017 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17018 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
17019 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017020
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017021res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17022 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17023 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17024 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17025 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017027res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17028shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17029 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17030 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17031 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17032 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17033 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
17034 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017036res.ver : string
17037resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17038 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
17039 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017041 ACL derivatives :
17042 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017044set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17045 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17046 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017047 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017050 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17051 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017053status : integer
17054 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17055 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
17056 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017057
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017058unique-id : string
17059 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17060 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17061 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17062 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17063 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17064 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066url : string
17067 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17068 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17069 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17070 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17071 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17072 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17073 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017075 ACL derivatives :
17076 url : exact string match
17077 url_beg : prefix match
17078 url_dir : subdir match
17079 url_dom : domain match
17080 url_end : suffix match
17081 url_len : length match
17082 url_reg : regex match
17083 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017085url_ip : ip
17086 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17087 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17088 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17089 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17090 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17091 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17092 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017094url_port : integer
17095 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17096 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17097 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17098 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017099
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017100urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17101url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017102 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17103 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017104 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17105 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17106 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17107 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17109 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017110 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17111 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017113 ACL derivatives :
17114 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17115 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17116 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17117 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17118 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17119 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17120 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17121 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017122
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017124 Example :
17125 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17126 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17127 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17128 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017129
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017130urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017131 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17132 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17133 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017134
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017135url32 : integer
17136 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17137 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17138 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17139 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17140 is an unsigned integer.
17141
17142url32+src : binary
17143 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17144 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17145 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17146
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010017147
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100171487.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
17149---------------------------------------
17150
17151This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17152used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17153purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17154There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17155or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17156any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17157for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17158
17159internal.htx.data : integer
17160 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17161 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17162
17163internal.htx.free : integer
17164 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17165 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17166
17167internal.htx.free_data : integer
17168 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17169 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17170
17171internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17172 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17173 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17174 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17175
17176internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17177 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17178 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17179
17180internal.htx.size : integer
17181 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17182 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17183
17184internal.htx.used : integer
17185 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17186 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17187 direction.
17188
17189internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17190 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17191 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17192 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17193 of the special value :
17194 * head : The oldest inserted block
17195 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017196 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017197
17198internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17199 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17200 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17201 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17202 integer or one of the special value :
17203 * head : The oldest inserted block
17204 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017205 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017206
17207internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17208 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17209 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17210 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17211 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17212
17213 * head : The oldest inserted block
17214 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017215 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017216
17217internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17218 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17219 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17220 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17221 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17222
17223 * head : The oldest inserted block
17224 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017225 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017226
17227internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
17228 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17229 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17230 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17231 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17232
17233 * head : The oldest inserted block
17234 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017235 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017236
17237internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
17238 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
17239 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
17240 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17241 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17242
17243 * head : The oldest inserted block
17244 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017245 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017246
17247internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
17248 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
17249 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
17250 it returns false.
17251
17252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200172537.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017254---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017256Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
17257every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020017258order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017260ACL name Equivalent to Usage
17261---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017262FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020017263HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017264HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
17265HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017266HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
17267HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
17268HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
17269HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
17270LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017271METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017272METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017273METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
17274METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
17275METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
17276METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020017277METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017278METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017279RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017280REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017281TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017282WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17283---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017284
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172868. Logging
17287----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017288
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017289One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17290provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17291very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17292provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17293state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017294to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017295headers.
17296
17297In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17298about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17299send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17300
17301 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17302 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17303 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17304 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17305 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017306 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017307 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308
17309The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17310allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17311as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17312while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17313real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17314delay.
17315
17316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173178.1. Log levels
17318---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017319
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017320TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017321source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017322HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17323in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17324track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17325syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17326about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017327
17328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173298.2. Log formats
17330----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017331
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017332HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017333and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17334slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17335options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017336
17337 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17338 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17339 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17340 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17341 extents.
17342
17343 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17344 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17345 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17346 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17347 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17348
17349 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17350 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17351 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17352 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17353 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17354
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017355 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17356 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17357 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17358 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17359
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017360 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17361
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017362Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17363specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17364field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17365servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17366always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17367identifier.
17368
17369Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17370 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17371 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17372 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17373 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17374
17375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173768.2.1. Default log format
17377-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017378
17379This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17380as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17381format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17382
17383 Example :
17384 listen www
17385 mode http
17386 log global
17387 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17388
17389 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17390 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17391 (www/HTTP)
17392
17393 Field Format Extract from the example above
17394 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17395 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17396 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17397 4 'to' to
17398 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17399 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17400
17401Detailed fields description :
17402 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17403 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17404 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17405 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17406 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17407 and processed the connection.
17408 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17409
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017410In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17411"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17412connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17413
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017414It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17415will eventually disappear.
17416
17417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174188.2.2. TCP log format
17419---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017420
17421The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17422is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17423information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17424counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17425emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17426environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17427the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17428sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017429specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17430not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17431fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17432marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017433
17434 Example :
17435 frontend fnt
17436 mode tcp
17437 option tcplog
17438 log global
17439 default_backend bck
17440
17441 backend bck
17442 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17443
17444 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17445 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17446 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17447
17448 Field Format Extract from the example above
17449 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17450 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17451 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17452 4 frontend_name fnt
17453 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17454 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17455 7 bytes_read* 212
17456 8 termination_state --
17457 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17458 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17459
17460Detailed fields description :
17461 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017462 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17463 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17464 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017465 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017466 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017467 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468
17469 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017470 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17471 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17472 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017473
17474 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17475 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17476 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017477 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17478 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17479 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17480 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017481
17482 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17483 and processed the connection.
17484
17485 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17486 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17487 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17488 applications.
17489
17490 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17491 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17492 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17493 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17494 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17495
17496 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17497 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17498 See "Timers" below for more details.
17499
17500 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17501 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17502 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17503 "Timers" below for more details.
17504
17505 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017506 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017507 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17508 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17509 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17510 details.
17511
17512 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17513 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17514 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17515 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17516 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17517
17518 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17519 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17520 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17521 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17522 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17523 for more details.
17524
17525 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017526 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017527 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17528 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17529 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017530 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531
17532 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17533 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17534 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17535 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17536 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17537 caused by a denial of service attack.
17538
17539 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17540 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17541 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17542 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17543 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17544 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17545 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17546 denial of service attack.
17547
17548 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17549 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17550 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17551 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17552 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17553 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17554 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17555 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17556 be processed than on other servers.
17557
17558 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17559 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17560 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17561 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17562 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17563 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17564 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17565 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17566 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17567 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17568 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17569 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17570 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17571
17572 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17573 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17574 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17575 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17576 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17577 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017578 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017579 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17580
17581 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17582 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17583 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17584 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17585 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17586 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017587 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017588 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17589 occurs.
17590
17591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175928.2.3. HTTP log format
17593----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017594
17595The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17596is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17597the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17598are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17599emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17600generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17601"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17602which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017603frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17604is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017605
17606Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17607slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17608with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17609
17610 Example :
17611 frontend http-in
17612 mode http
17613 option httplog
17614 log global
17615 default_backend bck
17616
17617 backend static
17618 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17619
17620 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17621 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17622 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017623 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017624
17625 Field Format Extract from the example above
17626 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17627 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017628 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017629 4 frontend_name http-in
17630 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017631 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632 7 status_code 200
17633 8 bytes_read* 2750
17634 9 captured_request_cookie -
17635 10 captured_response_cookie -
17636 11 termination_state ----
17637 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17638 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17639 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17640 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17641 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017642
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643Detailed fields description :
17644 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017645 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17646 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17647 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017648 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017649 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017650 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017651
17652 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017653 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17654 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17655 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017656
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017657 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17658 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017659
17660 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17661 and processed the connection.
17662
17663 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17664 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17665 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17666
17667 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17668 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17669 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17670 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17671 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17672 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17673
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017674 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17675 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17676 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017677 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017678 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17679 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017680 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17681 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017682
17683 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17684 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017685 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017686
17687 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17688 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017689 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17690 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017691
17692 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17693 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17694 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17695 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17696 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017697 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17698 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017700 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17701 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17702 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17703 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17704 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17705 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17706 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017707 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017708
17709 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17710 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17711 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17712
17713 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17714 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017715 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017716 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17717 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17718 overflowing.
17719
17720 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17721 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17722 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17723 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17724 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17725 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17726 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17727 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17728
17729 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17730 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17731 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17732 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17733 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17734 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17735 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17736 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17737
17738 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17739 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17740 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17741 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17742 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17743 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17744 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17745
17746 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017747 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017748 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17749 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17750 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017751 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017752 system.
17753
17754 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17755 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17756 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17757 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17758 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17759 caused by a denial of service attack.
17760
17761 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17762 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17763 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17764 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17765 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17766 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17767 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17768 denial of service attack.
17769
17770 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17771 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17772 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17773 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17774 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17775 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17776 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17777 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17778 processed than on other servers.
17779
17780 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17781 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17782 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17783 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17784 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17785 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17786 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17787 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17788 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17789 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17790 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17791 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17792 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17793
17794 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17795 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17796 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17797 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17798 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17799 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017800 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017801 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17802
17803 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17804 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17805 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17806 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17807 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17808 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017809 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017810 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17811 occurs.
17812
17813 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17814 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17815 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17816 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17817 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17818 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17819 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17820 cookies" below for more details.
17821
17822 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17823 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17824 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17825 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17826 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17827 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17828 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17829 and cookies" below for more details.
17830
17831 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17832 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17833 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17834 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17835 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17836 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17837 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17838 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17839
17840
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200178418.2.4. Custom log format
17842------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017843
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017844The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017845mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017846
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017847HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017848Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17849separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17850prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17851
17852Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17853variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017854("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017855
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017856If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017857as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017858less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17859the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17860
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017861Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017862In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017863in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017864
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017865Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17866'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17867https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17868such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17869
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017870Flags are :
17871 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017872 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017873 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17874 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017875
17876 Example:
17877
17878 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17879 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17880
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017881 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17882
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017883At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17884
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017885 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17886 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017887
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017888the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017889
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017890 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17891 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17892 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017893
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017894and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17895
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017896 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17897 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017898
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017899Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17900
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017901 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017902 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017903 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17904 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17905 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017906 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17907 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17908 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017909 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017910 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17911 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017912 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017913 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17914 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017915 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017916 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017917 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017918 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017919 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017920 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017921 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017922 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17923 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17924 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17925 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17926 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017927 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017928 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17929 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017930 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017931 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17932 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017933 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17934 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17935 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017936 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017937 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17938 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017939 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017940 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17941 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17942 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017943 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017944 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017945 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17946 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17947 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17948 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017949 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017950 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017951 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017952 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017953 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017954 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017955 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17956 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17957 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017958 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017959 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17960 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017961 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017962 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17963 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017964 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017965 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017966 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017967 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017968
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017969 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017970
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017971
179728.2.5. Error log format
17973-----------------------
17974
17975When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17976protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17977By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17978"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017979will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017980logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17981
17982The format looks like this :
17983
17984 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17985 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17986 Connection error during SSL handshake
17987
17988 Field Format Extract from the example above
17989 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17990 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17991 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17992 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17993 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17994
17995These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17996failures.
17997
17998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179998.3. Advanced logging options
18000-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018001
18002Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18003just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18004options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18005for more information about their usage.
18006
18007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180088.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18009------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018010
18011It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18012haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18013commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18014monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18015ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18016
18017 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18018 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18019 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18020 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18021
18022 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18023 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18024 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018025 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018026 such as other load-balancers.
18027
18028 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18029 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18030 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18031
18032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180338.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18034----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018035
18036The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18037what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18038or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018039"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018040just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18041log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18042after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18043is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18044with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18045with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18046
18047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180488.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18049------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018050
18051Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18052for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18053"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18054retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18055raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18056a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18057file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18058you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18059"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18060
18061
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180628.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18063--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018064
18065Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18066multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18067them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18068"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18069logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18070error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18071and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18072too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18073useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18074alternative.
18075
18076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180778.4. Timing events
18078------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018079
18080Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18081reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18082the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18083frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018084mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18085addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18086
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018087Timings events in HTTP mode:
18088
18089 first request 2nd request
18090 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18091 t tr t tr ...
18092 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18093 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18094 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18095 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
18096 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18097
18098Timings events in TCP mode:
18099
18100 TCP session
18101 |<----------------->|
18102 t t
18103 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18104 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18105 |<------ Tt ------->|
18106
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018107 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018108 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018109 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18110 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18111 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018112 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018113 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18114 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18115 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18116 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018118 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18119 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18120 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018121 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18122 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18123 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18124 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18125 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18126 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018127
18128 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18129 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18130 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18131 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18132 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18133 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18134 request typed by hand during a test.
18135
18136 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18137 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018138 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018139 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18140 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18141 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18142 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018143
18144 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18145 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18146 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18147 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18148 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18149
18150 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18151 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18152 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18153 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18154 connection never established.
18155
18156 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18157 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18158 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18159 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18160 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18161 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18162 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18163 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18164 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18165 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18166 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18167
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018168 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18169 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18170 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18171 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18172 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18173 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18174
18175 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18176
18177 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18178 "Ta" can never be negative.
18179
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018180 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18181 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018182 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18183 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018184 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018185
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018186 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018187
18188 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018189 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18190 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018191
18192These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18193protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18194that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018195due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18196"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18197that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018198
18199Most common cases :
18200
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018201 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18202 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18203 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18204 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18205 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18206 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18207 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18208 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18209 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
18210 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
18211 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020018212 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018213
18214 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
18215 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
18216 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
18217 of ms on remote networks.
18218
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018219 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
18220 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
18221 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018222
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018223 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
18224 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
18225 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
18226 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
18227 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
18228 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
18229 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
18230 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
18231 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018232
18233Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
18234
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018235 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018236 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018237 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018238
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018239 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018240 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
18241 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
18242
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018243 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018244 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
18245 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
18246 flags.
18247
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018248 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
18249 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018250 Check the session termination flags, then check the
18251 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
18252 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
18253 the client connection was maintained open.
18254
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018255 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018256 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018257 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018258 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
18259
18260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182618.5. Session state at disconnection
18262-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018263
18264TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
18265"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
182662-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
18267each of which has a special meaning :
18268
18269 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
18270 session to terminate :
18271
18272 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
18273
18274 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
18275 server explicitly refused it.
18276
18277 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
18278 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
18279 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
18280 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018281 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018282
18283 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18284 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018285
18286 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18287 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18288 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18289 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18290 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18291
18292 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18293 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18294 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18295 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18296 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18297
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018298 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18299 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18300
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018301 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18302 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18303 backup connections when going up.
18304
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018305 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18306
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018307 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18308 send or receive data.
18309
18310 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18311 send or receive data.
18312
18313 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18314 with nothing left in the buffers.
18315
18316 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18317
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018318 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018319 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18320
18321 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18322 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18323 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18324 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18325 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18326
18327 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18328 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18329
18330 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18331 server (HTTP only).
18332
18333 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18334
18335 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18336 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18337 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18338
18339 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18340 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18341 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18342
18343 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18344
18345 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18346 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18347
18348 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18349 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18350 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18351
18352 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18353 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018354 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18355 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018356
18357 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18358 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18359 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18360 another server.
18361
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018362 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018363 server.
18364
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018365 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18366 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18367 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18368 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18369
18370 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18371 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18372 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18373 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18374
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018375 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18376 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18377 "use-server" rule).
18378
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018379 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18380
18381 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18382 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18383
18384 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18385
18386 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18387 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18388 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18389
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018390 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18391 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018392 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018393 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18394 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18395
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018396 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18397
18398 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18399 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18400
18401 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18402
18403 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18404
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018405The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18406was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018407helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18408starvation, attacks, etc...
18409
18410The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18411alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18412easier finding and understanding.
18413
18414 Flags Reason
18415
18416 -- Normal termination.
18417
18418 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18419 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18420 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18421 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18422
18423 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18424 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18425 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18426 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18427 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18428 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018429
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018430 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18431 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018432 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018433
18434 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18435 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18436 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18437
18438 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18439 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18440 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18441 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18442 the server takes too long to respond.
18443
18444 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18445 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18446 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18447 long a time to respond.
18448
18449 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18450 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18451 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18452 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018453 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18454 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018455
18456 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18457 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18458 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18459 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18460 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018461 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018462 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18463 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18464 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18465 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18466 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18467 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18468 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18469 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018470 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018471 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18472 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18473 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018474
18475 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18476 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018477 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18478 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18479 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18480 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018481
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018482 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18483 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018485 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018486 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18487 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018488 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018489 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18490 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18491
18492 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18493 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18494 503 or 504 here.
18495
18496 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18497 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18498 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18499 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18500 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18501
18502 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18503 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018504 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018505 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18506 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18507
18508 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18509 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18510 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18511 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18512 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18513 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18514 between haproxy and the server.
18515
18516 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18517 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18518 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18519 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18520 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18521 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18522 solution is to fix the application.
18523
18524 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18525 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18526 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18527 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18528 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18529 external attacks.
18530
18531 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18532 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018533 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018534 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18535 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18536
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018537 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18538 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18539 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018540 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018541 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018542
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018543 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18544 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18545 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18546 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018547 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18548 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18549 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18550 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18551 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018552
18553 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18554 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18555 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18556 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18557
18558 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18559 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18560 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18561 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18562
18563 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18564 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18565 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18566 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18567
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018568The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18569persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18570important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18571re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18572
18573 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18574
18575 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18576 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18577 set on a GET request.
18578
18579 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18580 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018581 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018582 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18583
18584 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18585 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18586 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18587
18588 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18589 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18590 already got a cookie.
18591
18592 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18593 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18594 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18595 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18596 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18597
18598 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18599 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18600 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18601
18602 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18603 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18604 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18605
18606 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18607 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18608
18609 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18610 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18611 then advertised in the response.
18612
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186148.6. Non-printable characters
18615-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018616
18617In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18618consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18619converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18620prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18621being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18622escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18623is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18624'}' when logging headers.
18625
18626Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18627issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18628containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18629
18630Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18631the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18632performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18633
18634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186358.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18636---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018637
18638Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18639achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018640section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018641cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18642the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18643the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018644locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018645not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18646user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18647a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18648wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18649
18650 Examples :
18651 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18652 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18653
18654 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18655 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18656
18657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186588.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18659---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018660
18661Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18662proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18663the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18664server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18665
18666Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18667response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018668section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018669
18670It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018671time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18672appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018673are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18674and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18675follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18676request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18677in the logs.
18678
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018679As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18680frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18681an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18682
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018683 Example :
18684 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18685 listen proxy-out
18686 mode http
18687 option httplog
18688 option logasap
18689 log global
18690 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18691
18692 # log the name of the virtual server
18693 capture request header Host len 20
18694
18695 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18696 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18697
18698 # log the beginning of the referrer
18699 capture request header Referer len 20
18700
18701 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18702 capture response header Server len 20
18703
18704 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18705 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18706
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018707 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018708 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18709
18710 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18711 capture response header Via len 20
18712
18713 # log the URL location during a redirection
18714 capture response header Location len 20
18715
18716 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18717 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18718 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18719 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18720 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18721
18722 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18723 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18724 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18725 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018726 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018727
18728 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18729 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18730 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18731 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18732 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018733 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018734
18735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187368.9. Examples of logs
18737---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018738
18739These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18740them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18741reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18742
18743 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18744 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18745 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18746
18747 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18748 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18749
18750 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18751 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18752 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18753
18754 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18755 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18756
18757 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18758 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18759 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18760
18761 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018762 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018763 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18764 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18765
18766 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18767 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18768 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18769
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018770 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18771 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18772 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18773 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18774 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18775 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018776
18777 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018778 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018779
18780 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18781 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18782 Nothing was sent to any server.
18783
18784 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18785 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18786
18787 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18788 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018789 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018790 send a 408 return code to the client.
18791
18792 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18793 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18794
18795 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18796 5 seconds ("c----").
18797
18798 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18799 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018800 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018801
18802 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018803 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018804 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18805 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18806 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18807 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18808 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018809
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018810
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200188119. Supported filters
18812--------------------
18813
18814Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18815accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18816unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18817
18818See also : "filter"
18819
188209.1. Trace
18821----------
18822
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018823filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018824
18825 Arguments:
18826 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18827 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18828
18829 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18830 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18831 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18832 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18833
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018834 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018835 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18836 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18837 amount of the parsed data.
18838
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018839 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018840
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018841This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18842callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18843information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18844filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18845
18846Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18847tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18848a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18849
18850
188519.2. HTTP compression
18852---------------------
18853
18854filter compression
18855
18856The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18857keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018858when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18859fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18860done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18861explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18862filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18863listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18864order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018865
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018866See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18867 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018868
18869
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200188709.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18871--------------------------------------------
18872
18873filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18874
18875 Arguments :
18876
18877 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18878 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18879 parsed.
18880
18881 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18882 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18883 part must be placed in its own scope.
18884
18885The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18886external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018887streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018888exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18889also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18890
18891SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18892the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18893
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018894For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018895"doc/SPOE.txt".
18896
18897Important note:
18898 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18899 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18900
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100189019.4. Cache
18902----------
18903
18904filter cache <name>
18905
18906 Arguments :
18907
18908 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18909
18910The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18911"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018912cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018913other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18914case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18915is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18916filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018917listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18918order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018919
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018920See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18921 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18922
18923
189249.5. Fcgi-app
18925-------------
18926
18927filter fcg-app <name>
18928
18929 Arguments :
18930
18931 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18932
18933The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18934request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18935reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18936used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18937implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18938used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18939fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18940used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18941order.
18942
18943See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18944 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18945
18946
1894710. FastCGI applications
18948-------------------------
18949
18950HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18951feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18952the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18953FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18954servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18955FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18956backend.
18957
18958HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18959application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18960connection.
18961
1896210.1. Setup
18963-----------
18964
1896510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18966--------------------------
18967
18968fcgi-app <name>
18969 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18970 document root must be defined.
18971
18972acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18973 Declare or complete an access list.
18974
18975 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18976 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18977 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18978 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18979 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18980
18981docroot <path>
18982 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18983 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18984 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18985
18986index <script-name>
18987 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18988 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18989 is an optional setting.
18990
18991 Example :
18992 index index.php
18993
18994log-stderr global
18995log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18996 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18997 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18998
18999 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19000 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19001
19002pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19003 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19004 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19005 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19006
19007 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19008 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19009 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19010 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19011
19012 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19013 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19014
19015path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019016 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019017 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19018 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19019 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19020 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19021 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19022 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19023 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019024
19025 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019026 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019027 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19028 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19029 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19030 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019031
19032 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019033 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19034 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019035
19036option get-values
19037no option get-values
19038 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19039
19040 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19041 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19042
19043 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19044 application will accept.
19045
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019046 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19047 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019048
19049 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19050 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19051 option is disabled.
19052
19053 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19054 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19055 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19056 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19057 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19058 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19059
19060option keep-conn
19061no option keep-conn
19062 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19063 sending a response.
19064
19065 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19066 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19067
19068option max-reqs <reqs>
19069 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19070 accept.
19071
19072 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19073 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19074 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19075 to 1.
19076
19077option mpxs-conns
19078no option mpxs-conns
19079 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19080
19081 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19082 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19083
19084set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19085 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19086 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19087 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19088 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19089
19090 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19091 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19092 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19093
19094 Example :
19095 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19096 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19097
19098 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19099
19100
1910110.1.2. Proxy section
19102---------------------
19103
19104use-fcgi-app <name>
19105 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19106
19107 Arguments :
19108 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19109
19110 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19111 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19112 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19113 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19114 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19115
19116 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19117 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19118 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19119 application are evaluated.
19120
19121
1912210.1.3. Example
19123---------------
19124
19125 frontend front-http
19126 mode http
19127 bind *:80
19128 bind *:
19129
19130 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19131 default_backend back-static
19132
19133 backend back-static
19134 mode http
19135 server www A.B.C.D:80
19136
19137 backend back-dynamic
19138 mode http
19139 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19140 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19141
19142 fcgi-app php-fpm
19143 log-stderr global
19144 option keep-conn
19145
19146 docroot /var/www/my-app
19147 index index.php
19148 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19149
19150
1915110.2. Default parameters
19152------------------------
19153
19154A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19155the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019156script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019157applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19158
19159 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19160 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19161 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19162 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19163 | | |
19164 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19165 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19166 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19167 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19168 | | application. |
19169 | | |
19170 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19171 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19172 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19173 | | |
19174 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19175 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19176 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19177 | | the application's configuration. |
19178 | | |
19179 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19180 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19181 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19182 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19183 | | |
19184 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19185 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19186 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19187 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19188 | | be defined. |
19189 | | |
19190 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19191 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19192 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19193 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19194 | | is not set too. |
19195 | | |
19196 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19197 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19198 | | set. |
19199 | | |
19200 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19201 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19202 | | the request. |
19203 | | |
19204 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19205 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19206 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19207 | | |
19208 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19209 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19210 | | script to process the request. |
19211 | | |
19212 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19213 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
19214 | | |
19215 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19216 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
19217 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
19218 | | |
19219 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19220 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
19221 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
19222 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
19223 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
19224 | | |
19225 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19226 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
19227 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
19228 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
19229 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
19230 | | side. |
19231 | | |
19232 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19233 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
19234 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
19235 | | connected to. |
19236 | | |
19237 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19238 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
19239 | | |
19240 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19241 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
19242 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
19243 | | |
19244 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19245
19246
1924710.3. Limitations
19248------------------
19249
19250The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
19251way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
19252during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
19253establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
19254application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
19255or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
19256message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
19257these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
19258and HTTP servers under the same backend.
19259
19260Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
19261request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
19262requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
19263
19264About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
19265into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
19266fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
19267"http-request" ones.
19268
19269Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
19270FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
19271processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
19272must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
19273here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010019274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019275/*
19276 * Local variables:
19277 * fill-column: 79
19278 * End:
19279 */